blob: b55a8077e14b9d4862ff69810acca484c9628db9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaub7ffe192020-10-10 10:45:13 +02007 2020/10/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
479list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
480arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
481before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
483 Example:
484
485 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
486
487 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
488
489 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
492file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
495 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
496
497* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
498 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
499 directory.
500
501* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 processes, separated by semicolons.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 CLI, separated by semicolons.
508
509See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200510
5112.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200512----------------
513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100514Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100515values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
516otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
517numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
518for every keyword. Supported units are :
519
520 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
521 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
522 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
523 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
524 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
525 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
526
527
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005282.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200529-------------
530
531 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
532 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
533 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
534 global
535 daemon
536 maxconn 256
537
538 defaults
539 mode http
540 timeout connect 5000ms
541 timeout client 50000ms
542 timeout server 50000ms
543
544 frontend http-in
545 bind *:80
546 default_backend servers
547
548 backend servers
549 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
550
551
552 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
553 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
554 global
555 daemon
556 maxconn 256
557
558 defaults
559 mode http
560 timeout connect 5000ms
561 timeout client 50000ms
562 timeout server 50000ms
563
564 listen http-in
565 bind *:80
566 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
567
568
569Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
570
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100571 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200572
573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005743. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575--------------------
576
577Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
578are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
579of them have command-line equivalents.
580
581The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
582
583 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200584 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - description
590 - deviceatlas-json-file
591 - deviceatlas-log-level
592 - deviceatlas-separator
593 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900594 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - gid
596 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100597 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200598 - h1-case-adjust
599 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100600 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100601 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100602 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200603 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200614 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200675 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200682 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100683 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100685 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.session-timeout
687 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200688 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100689 - tune.maxaccept
690 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200691 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200692 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200693 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200694 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
695 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200700 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100701 - tune.sndbuf.client
702 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100703 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200704 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100705 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200706 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100707 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200708 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200709 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100710 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200711 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100712 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200713 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
714 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
715 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100716 - tune.zlib.memlevel
717 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100718
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200721 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725------------------------------------
726
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727ca-base <dir>
728 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100729 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
730 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
731 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733chroot <jail dir>
734 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
735 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
736 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
737 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
738 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100740
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
742 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
743 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
744 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
745 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
746 set. These sets have the format
747
748 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
749
750 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
753 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100754 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
755 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100756 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100757 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100759 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
761 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
762 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
763 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100764
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100765 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
766 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
767 on the machine's word size.
768
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100770 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
771 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
772 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
773 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
774 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
775 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776
777 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
779
780 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
781 # first 4 CPUs
782
783 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
784 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
785 # word size.
786
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
792
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100793 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
794 # and so on.
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100800 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
801 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
802 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
803
804 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
805 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
807
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100808 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
809 # and a thread range.
810 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
811 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
813
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814crt-base <dir>
815 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100816 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
817 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819daemon
820 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
821 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100822 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
823 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825deviceatlas-json-file <path>
826 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828
829deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200831 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
832
833deviceatlas-separator <char>
834 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
835 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
836
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100837deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200838 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
839 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
840 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100841
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900842external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100843 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
844 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100845 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
846 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
847 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
848 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
849 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851gid <number>
852 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
853 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
854 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100855 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
856 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100858
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100859group <group name>
860 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
861 See also "gid" and "user".
862
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100863hard-stop-after <time>
864 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
865
866 Arguments :
867 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
868 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
869 SIGUSR1 signal.
870
871 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
872 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
873 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
874
875 Example:
876 global
877 hard-stop-after 30s
878
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200879h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
880 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
881 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
882 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
883 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500884 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200885 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
886 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
887 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
888 specified in a proxy.
889
890 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
891 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
892 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
893 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
894 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
895 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
896 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
897
898 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
899 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
900 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
901 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
902 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
903
904 Example:
905 global
906 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
907
908 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
909 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
910
911h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
912 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
913 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
914 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
915 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
916 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
917 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
918 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
919 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
920
921 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
922 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
923 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
924
925 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
926 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
927
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100928insecure-fork-wanted
929 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
930 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
931 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
932 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
933 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
934 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
935 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
936 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
937 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
938 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
939 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
940 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
941 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
942 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
943 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
944 disable it.
945
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100946insecure-setuid-wanted
947 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
948 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
949 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
950 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
951 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
952 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
953 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
954 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
955 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
956 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
957 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
958 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
959 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
960 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
961
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100962issuers-chain-path <dir>
963 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
964 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
965 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
966 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
967 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
968 "issuers-chain-path".
969 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
970 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
971 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
972 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
973 will share the chain in memory.
974
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200975localpeer <name>
976 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
977 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
978 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
979 the configuration parsing.
980
981 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
982 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
983
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200984log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
985 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100986 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 configured with "log global".
989
990 <address> can be one of:
991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100992 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100993 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
994 port).
995
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100996 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
997 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
998 port).
999
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001000 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001001 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1002 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001003 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001004
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001005 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1006 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1007 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1008 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1009 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1010 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1011 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1012 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1013 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1014 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1015 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1016 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1017 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1018 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001019 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1020 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001021
1022 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1023 "fd@2", see above.
1024
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001025 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1026 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1027 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1028 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1029 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1030
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001031 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1032 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001033
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001034 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1035 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1036 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1037 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1038 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1039 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1040 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1041 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1042 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1043 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1045 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001046
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001047 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1048 one of the following :
1049
1050 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1051 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1052
1053 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1055
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001056 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1057 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1058 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1059 designed to be used with a local log server.
1060
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001061 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1062 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1063 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1064 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1065 logger consumes.
1066
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001067 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1068 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1069 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1070 used with a local log server.
1071
1072 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1073 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1074 designed to be used with a local log server.
1075
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001076 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1077 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1078 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1079 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1080
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001081 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1082 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1083 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1084 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1085 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1086
1087 <sample_size>
1088 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1089 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1090 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1091 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1092 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1093
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001094 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001095
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001096 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1097 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1098 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1099
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001100 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1101 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1102 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1103 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104
1105 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001106 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1107 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1108 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1109 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1110 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1111 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001113 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001115log-send-hostname [<string>]
1116 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1117 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1118 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1119 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1120 the logs.
1121
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001122log-tag <string>
1123 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1124 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1125 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001126 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001127
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001128lua-load <file>
1129 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1130 used multiple times.
1131
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001132lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1133 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1134 variable.
1135 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1136 to "path".
1137
1138 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1139 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1140 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1141 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1142 will be checked earlier.
1143
1144 As an example by specifying the following path:
1145
1146 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1147 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1148
1149 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1150 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1151 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1152 paths if that does not exist either.
1153
1154 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1155 documentation.
1156
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001157master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001158 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1159 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1160 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001161 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001162 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1163 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001164 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1165 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1166 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1167 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1168 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001170 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001171
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001172mworker-max-reloads <number>
1173 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001174 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001175 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1176 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1177 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1178
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001179nbproc <number>
1180 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1181 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1182 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001183 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1184 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001185 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1186 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001187
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001188nbthread <number>
1189 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001190 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1191 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1192 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1193 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1194 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001195 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1196 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1197 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1198 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1199 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1200 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1201 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001204 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1205 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1206 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1207 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001209pp2-never-send-local
1210 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1211 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1212 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1213 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1214 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1215 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1216 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1217 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1218 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1219 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1220 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1221
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001222presetenv <name> <value>
1223 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1224 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1225 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1226 and "unsetenv".
1227
1228resetenv [<name> ...]
1229 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1230 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1231 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1232 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1233 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1234 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1235 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1236 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1237
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001238stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001239 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1240 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1241 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1242 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1243 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1244 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001245 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001246 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1247 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1248 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1249 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001250
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001251server-state-base <directory>
1252 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001253 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1254 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001255
1256server-state-file <file>
1257 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1258 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1259 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1260 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1261 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1262 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1263 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1264 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001265 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1266 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001267
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001268setenv <name> <value>
1269 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1270 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1271 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1272 and "unsetenv".
1273
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001274set-dumpable
1275 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001276 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1277 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1278 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1279 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1280 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1281 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1282 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1283 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1284 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1285 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1286 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1287 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1288 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1289 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1290 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1291 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1292 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001293
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001294ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1296 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001297 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001298 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001299 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1300 information and recommendations see e.g.
1301 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1302 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1303 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1304 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001305
1306ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1308 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1309 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1310 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1311 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001312 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1313 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1314 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001315 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001316
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001317ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1319 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1320 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1321 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1322 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1323
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001324ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1326 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1327 keyword to see available options.
1328
1329 Example:
1330 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001331 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001332
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001333ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1335 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001336 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001337 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001338 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1339 information and recommendations see e.g.
1340 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1341 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1342 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1343 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1344 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001345
1346ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1348 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1349 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1350 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1351 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001352 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1353 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1354 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1355 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001356
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001357ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1359 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1360 keyword to see available options.
1361
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001362ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1364 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1365 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001366 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001367 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001368 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1369 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1370 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1371 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001372 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1373 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1374 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1375
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001376ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001377 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001378 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1379 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001380
1381 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1382 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1383 optimize the startup time.
1384
1385 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1386 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1387 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1388
1389 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001390 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001391
1392 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001393 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1394
1395 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1396 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1397 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1398 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1399 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1400 bind configuration..
1401
1402 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1403 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1404 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1405 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1406 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1407 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1408 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1409 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1410
1411 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1412
1413 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1414 a cert bundle.
1415
1416 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1417 separately in several "crt".
1418
1419 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1420 since files are loading separately.
1421
1422 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1423 required to commit them.
1424
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001425 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001426 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001427
1428 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1429
1430 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1431
1432 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1433 not provided in the PEM file.
1434
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001435 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1436 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1437
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001438 The default behavior is "all".
1439
1440 Example:
1441 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1442 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1443 ssl-load-extra-files none
1444
1445 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1446
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001447ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1448 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1449 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1450 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1451
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001452ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001453 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001454 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1455 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1456 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1457 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1458 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1459 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001460 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001461
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001462stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1463 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1464 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1465 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001466 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001467 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001468
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001469 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1470 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1471 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001472
1473stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1474 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1475 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001476 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001477
1478stats maxconn <connections>
1479 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1480 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001482uid <number>
1483 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1484 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1485 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1486 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1487
1488ulimit-n <number>
1489 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1490 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1491 option.
1492
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001493unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1494 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1495
1496 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1497 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1498 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1499 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1500 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1501 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1502 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1503 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1504 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1505 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1506
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001507unsetenv [<name> ...]
1508 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1509 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1510 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1511 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1512 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1513 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1514 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001516user <user name>
1517 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1518 See also "uid" and "group".
1519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001520node <name>
1521 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1522
1523 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1524 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1525 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1526 traffic.
1527
1528description <text>
1529 Add a text that describes the instance.
1530
1531 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1532 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1533 "<" and ">" characters.
1534
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100153551degrees-data-file <file path>
1536 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001537 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001538
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001540 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1541
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000154251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001543 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1544 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1545 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1546
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001548 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1549
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200155051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001551 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1552 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1553
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001554 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1555 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1556
155751degrees-cache-size <number>
1558 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1559 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1560 By default, this cache is disabled.
1561
1562 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001563 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1564
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001565wurfl-data-file <file path>
1566 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1567 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1568
1569 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1570 with USE_WURFL=1.
1571
1572wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1573 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1574 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1575 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1576
1577 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1578
1579 Valid WURFL properties are:
1580 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1581
1582 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1583 device.
1584
1585 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1586 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1587
1588 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1589 particular web request.
1590
1591 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1592 used Libwurfl API version.
1593
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001594 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1595 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1596
1597 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1598 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1599
1600 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1601
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001602 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1603 with USE_WURFL=1.
1604
1605wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1606 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1607 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1608
1609 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1610 with USE_WURFL=1.
1611
1612wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1613 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1614 thus before the chroot.
1615
1616 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1617 with USE_WURFL=1.
1618
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001619wurfl-cache-size <size>
1620 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1621 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001622 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001623 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001624
1625 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1626 with USE_WURFL=1.
1627
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001628strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001629 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1630 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1631 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1632 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1633 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016353.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001636-----------------------
1637
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001638busy-polling
1639 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1640 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1641 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1642 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1643 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1644 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1645 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1646 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1647 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1648 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1649 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1650 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1651 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1652 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1653 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1654 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1655 "poll" pollers.
1656
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001657 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1658 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1659 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1660
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001661max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1662 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1663 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1664 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1665 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1666 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1667 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1668 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1669 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001671maxconn <number>
1672 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1673 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1674 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001675 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1676 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1677 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1678 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001679 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1680 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1681 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1682 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1683 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1684 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001685
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001686maxconnrate <number>
1687 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1688 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1689 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1690 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1691 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1692 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1693 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1694 fairness.
1695
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001696maxcomprate <number>
1697 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001698 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001699 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1700 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1701 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001702 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001703 default value.
1704
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001705maxcompcpuusage <number>
1706 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1707 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1708 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1709 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1710 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1711 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1712 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1713 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1714
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001715maxpipes <number>
1716 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1717 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1718 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1719 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1720 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1721 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1722
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001723maxsessrate <number>
1724 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1725 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1726 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1727 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1728 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1729 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1730 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1731 fairness.
1732
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001733maxsslconn <number>
1734 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1735 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1736 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1737 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1738 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1739 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1740 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001741 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1742 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1743 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1744 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1745 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1746 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1747 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001748
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001749maxsslrate <number>
1750 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1751 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1752 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1753 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1754 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1755 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1756 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1757 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1758 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1759 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1760
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001761maxzlibmem <number>
1762 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1763 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1764 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001765 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1766 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1767 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1768
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001769noepoll
1770 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1771 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001772 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001773
1774nokqueue
1775 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1776 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1777 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1778
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001779noevports
1780 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1781 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1782 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1783 also "nopoll".
1784
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001785nopoll
1786 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1787 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001788 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001789 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1790 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001791
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001792nosplice
1793 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001795 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001796 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001797 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1798 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1799 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1800 "option splice-response".
1801
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001802nogetaddrinfo
1803 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1804 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1805
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001806noreuseport
1807 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1808 command line argument "-dR".
1809
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001810profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1811 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1812 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1813 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1814 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001815 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001816 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1817 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1818 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1819 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1820
1821 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1822 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1823 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1824 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1825 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001826 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1827 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1828 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1829 CLI.
1830
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001831spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001832 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1833 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1834 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1835 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1836 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1837 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001838
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001840 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001842 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1843 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1844 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1845 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1846 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001847 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1848 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001849 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1850 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1851 openssl configuration file uses:
1852 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1853
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001854ssl-mode-async
1855 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001856 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001857 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1858 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1859 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001860 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001861 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001862
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001863tune.buffers.limit <number>
1864 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1865 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1866 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1867 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1868 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001869 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001870 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1871 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1872 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1873 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1874 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1875 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1876 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1877 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1878 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1879
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001880tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1881 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1882 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1883 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1884 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1885
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001886tune.bufsize <number>
1887 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1888 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1889 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1890 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1891 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1892 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1893 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001894 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1895 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1896 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001897 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001898 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1899 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1900 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001901
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001902tune.chksize <number>
1903 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1904 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1905 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1906 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1907 checks whenever possible.
1908
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001909tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1910 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1911 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1912 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1913 this value. The default value is 1.
1914
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001915tune.fail-alloc
1916 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1917 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1918 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1919 gracefully.
1920
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001921tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1922 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1923 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1924 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1925 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1926 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1927
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001928tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1929 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1930 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1931 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1932 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1933 change it.
1934
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001935tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1936 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001937 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1938 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001939 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1940 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1941 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1942 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1943 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1944
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001945tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1946 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1947 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1948 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1949 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1950 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1951 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1952 recommended not to change this value.
1953
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001954tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1955 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1956 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1957 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1958 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1959 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1960 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1961 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1962
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001963tune.http.cookielen <number>
1964 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1965 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1966 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1967 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1968 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1969 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1970 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1971 to change this value.
1972
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001973tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001974 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1975 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001976 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001977 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001978 configuration directives too.
1979 The default value is 1024.
1980
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001981tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1982 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1983 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1984 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1985 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1986 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1987 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001988 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1989 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1990 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001991
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001992tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1993 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1994 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1995 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1996 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1997 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1998 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1999 this option to "off". The default is on.
2000
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002001tune.idletimer <timeout>
2002 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2003 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2004 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2005 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2006 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2007 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002008 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002009 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002010 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2011
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002012tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2013 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2014 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2015 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2016 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2017 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2018 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2019 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2020 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2021 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2022
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002023tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2024 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002025 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002026 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2027 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002028 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002029 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2030 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2031
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002032tune.lua.maxmem
2033 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2034 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2035 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2036 memory.
2037
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002038tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2039 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002040 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2041 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002042 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002043
2044tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2045 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2046 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2047 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2048 check servers.
2049
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002050tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2051 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2052 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2053 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002054 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002055
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002056tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002057 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2058 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2059 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2060 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2061 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2062 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2063 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2064 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2065 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2066 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002067
2068tune.maxpollevents <number>
2069 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2070 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2071 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2072 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2073 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2074
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002075tune.maxrewrite <number>
2076 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2077 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2078 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2079 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2080 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2081 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2082 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2083 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2084 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2085 bufsize.
2086
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002087tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2088 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2089 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2090 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2091 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2092 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2093 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2094 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2095 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2096 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002097 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2098 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002099 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2100 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2101 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2102 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2103 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2104 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2105 setting this parameter to 0.
2106
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002107tune.pipesize <number>
2108 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2109 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2110 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2111 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2112 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2113 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2114
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002115tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2116 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2117 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2118 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2119 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2120 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2121 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002122 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002123
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002124tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2125 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2126 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2127 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2128 default is 20.
2129
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002130tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2131tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2132 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2133 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2134 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002135 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002136 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002137 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2138 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2139
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002140tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002141 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002142 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2143 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2144 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2145 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2146
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002147tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002148 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002149 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002150 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2151 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2152 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2153
2154tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2155 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2156 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2157 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2158 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2159 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2160 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2161 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2162 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2163 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002164
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002165tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2166tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2167 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2168 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2169 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002170 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002172 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2173 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2174 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2175 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2176 notifying haproxy again.
2177
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002178tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002179 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2180 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2181 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002182 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002183 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002184 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002185 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2186 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2187 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002188 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2189 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002190
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002191tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002192 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002193 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2194 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2195 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2196 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2197 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2198
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002199tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2200 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2201 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2202 performances. This is disabled by default.
2203
2204 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2205 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2206
2207 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2208
2209 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2210
2211 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2212
2213 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2214 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2215 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2216
2217 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2218 converted.
2219
2220 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2221 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2222 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2223 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2224 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2225 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2226 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002227 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2228 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002229
2230 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2231
2232 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2233 only need this line:
2234
2235 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2236
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002237tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2238 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002239 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002240 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2241 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2242 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2243 being used for too long.
2244
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002245tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2246 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2247 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2248 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2249 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2250 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2251 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2252 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2253 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2254 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2255 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002256 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002257 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002258
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002259tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2260 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2261 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2262 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2263 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002264 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002265 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2266 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002267 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2268 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002269
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002270tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2271 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2272 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2273 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2274 1000 entries.
2275
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002276tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2277 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2278 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2279 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2280
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002281tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002282tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002283tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2284tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2285tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002286 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2287 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2288 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2289 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2290 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2291 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2292 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2293 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002294
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002295 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2296 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2297 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2298 all available space is consumed.
2299 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2300 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2301 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002302
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002303tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2304 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002305 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002306 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002307 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002308 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2309
2310tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2311 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2312 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2314 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023163.3. Debugging
2317--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002318
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319quiet
2320 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2321 line argument "-q".
2322
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002323zero-warning
2324 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2325 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2326 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2327 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2328 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2329 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2330
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023323.4. Userlists
2333--------------
2334It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2335http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2336it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2337
2338userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002339 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002340 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2341
2342group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002343 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002344 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2345 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2346
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002347user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2348 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002349 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2350 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002351 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2352 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2353 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2354 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002355
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002356 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2357 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2358 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2359 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2360 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2361 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2362 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2363 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2364 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002365
2366 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002367 userlist L1
2368 group G1 users tiger,scott
2369 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002370
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002371 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2372 user scott insecure-password elgato
2373 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002374
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002375 userlist L2
2376 group G1
2377 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002378
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002379 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2380 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2381 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002382
2383 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002384
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002385
23863.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002387----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002388It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2389several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2390instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2391values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2392automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2393In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2394using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2395tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2396reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2397Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2398that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2399each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002400
2401peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002402 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002403 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2404
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002405bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2406 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2407 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2408
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002409disabled
2410 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2411 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2412 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2413
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002414default-bind [param*]
2415 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2416
2417default-server [param*]
2418 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2419
2420 Arguments:
2421 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2422 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2423 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2424 details.
2425
2426
2427 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2428
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002429enable
2430 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2431
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002432log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2433 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2434 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2435 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2436 more details.
2437
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002438peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002439 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2440 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002441 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2442 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2443 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2444 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2445 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002446
2447 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2448 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2449
2450 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002451 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2452 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2453 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002454
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002455 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2456 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002457
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002458 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2459 "server" keyword explanation below).
2460
2461server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002462 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002463 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2464 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2465 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2466 of this "peers" section).
2467 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2468
2469
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002470 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002471 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002472 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002473 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2474 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2475 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002476
2477 backend mybackend
2478 mode tcp
2479 balance roundrobin
2480 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2481 stick on src
2482
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002483 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2484 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002485
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002486 Example:
2487 peers mypeers
2488 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2489 default-server ssl verify none
2490 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2491 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002492
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002493
2494table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2495 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2496
2497 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2498 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002499 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002500 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2501 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2502 "stick-table" keyword).
2503
2504 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2505 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2506 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2507 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2508 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2509 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2510 of the stick-table name as follows:
2511
2512 peers mypeers
2513 peer A ...
2514 peer B ...
2515 table t1 ...
2516
2517 frontend fe1
2518 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2519
2520 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2521 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2522
2523 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2524 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2525 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2526 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2527 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2528 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2529 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2530
2531 peers mypeers
2532 peer A ...
2533 peer B ...
2534 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2535
2536 backend t1
2537 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2538
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002539 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002540 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2541 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2542
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025433.6. Mailers
2544------------
2545It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2546If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2547in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2548
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002549mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002550 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2551 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2552
2553mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2554 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2555
2556 Example:
2557 mailers mymailers
2558 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2559 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2560
2561 backend mybackend
2562 mode tcp
2563 balance roundrobin
2564
2565 email-alert mailers mymailers
2566 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2567 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2568
2569 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2570 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2571
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002572timeout mail <time>
2573 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2574 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2575 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2576 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2577
2578 Example:
2579 mailers mymailers
2580 timeout mail 20s
2581 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002582
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025833.7. Programs
2584-------------
2585In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2586master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2587managed the same way as the workers.
2588
2589During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2590sequence as a worker:
2591
2592 - the master is re-executed
2593 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2594 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2595 instance of the program
2596
2597During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2598
2599program <name>
2600 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2601 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2602 the management guide).
2603
2604command <command> [arguments*]
2605 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2606 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2607 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2608 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2609
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002610user <user name>
2611 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2612 See also "group".
2613
2614group <group name>
2615 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2616 See also "user".
2617
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002618option start-on-reload
2619no option start-on-reload
2620 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2621 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2622 program section.
2623
2624
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026253.8. HTTP-errors
2626----------------
2627
2628It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2629imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2630several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2631
2632http-errors <name>
2633 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2634 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2635
2636errorfile <code> <file>
2637 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2638
2639 Arguments :
2640 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002641 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2642 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002643
2644 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2645 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2646 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2647 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2648 before any chroot is performed.
2649
2650 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2651
2652 Example:
2653 http-errors website-1
2654 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2655 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2656 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2657
2658 http-errors website-2
2659 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2660 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2661 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2662
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026633.9. Rings
2664----------
2665
2666It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2667servers or traces.
2668
2669ring <ringname>
2670 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2671
2672description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002673 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002674 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2675
2676format <format>
2677 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2678
2679 Arguments:
2680 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2681 one of the following :
2682
2683 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2684 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2685 designed to be used with a local log server.
2686
2687 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2688 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2689 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2690 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2691 is the default.
2692
2693 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2694 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2695
2696 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2697 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2698
2699 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2700 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2701 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2702 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2703 logger consumes.
2704
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002705 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2706 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2707 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2708 with a local log server.
2709
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002710 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2711 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2712 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2713 used with a local log server.
2714
2715maxlen <length>
2716 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2717 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2718 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2719
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002720server <name> <address> [param*]
2721 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2722 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2723 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2724 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2725 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2726 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2727 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2728 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2729 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002730 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2731 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002732
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002733size <size>
2734 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2735 set to BUFSIZE.
2736
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002737timeout connect <timeout>
2738 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2739
2740 Arguments :
2741 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2743 as explained at the top of this document.
2744
2745timeout server <timeout>
2746 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2747
2748 Arguments :
2749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2751 as explained at the top of this document.
2752
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002753 Example:
2754 global
2755 log ring@myring local7
2756
2757 ring myring
2758 description "My local buffer"
2759 format rfc3164
2760 maxlen 1200
2761 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002762 timeout connect 5s
2763 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002764 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002765
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027663.10. Log forwarding
2767-------------------
2768
2769It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2770haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2771
2772log-forward <name>
2773 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2774
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002775backlog <conns>
2776 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2777 on connections accept.
2778
2779bind <addr> [param*]
2780 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02002781 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
2782 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
2783 syslog protocol over TCP.
2784 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002785 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
2786
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002787dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002788 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
2789 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
2790 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
2791 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002792 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002793
2794log global
2795log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2796 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2797 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2798 documentation.
2799 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2800 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2801 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2802 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2803 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2804
2805 Example:
2806 global
2807 log stderr format iso local7
2808
2809 ring myring
2810 description "My local buffer"
2811 format rfc5424
2812 maxlen 1200
2813 size 32764
2814 timeout connect 5s
2815 timeout server 10s
2816 # syslog tcp server
2817 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2818
2819 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002820 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
2821 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002822 # all messages on stderr
2823 log global
2824 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2825 log ring@myring local0
2826 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2827 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2828 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2829 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2830 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002831
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002832maxconn <conns>
2833 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
2834 10 is the default.
2835
2836timeout client <timeout>
2837 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028394. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002840----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002842Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002843 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002844 - frontend <name>
2845 - backend <name>
2846 - listen <name>
2847
2848A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2849its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2850section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002851section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002852
2853A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2854connections.
2855
2856A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2857to forward incoming connections.
2858
2859A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2860parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2861
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2863'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2864case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2865
2866Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2867logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2868proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2869However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2870name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2871
2872Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2873and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002874bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2876modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2877arbitrary criteria.
2878
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002879In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2880a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002881the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002882
2883 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2884 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2885 between responses and new requests.
2886
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002887 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2888 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2889 client-facing connection remains open.
2890
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002891 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2892 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002893
2894The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2895frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2896following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002897weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002898
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002899 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002900
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002901 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2902 ----+-----+-----+----
2903 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2904 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002905 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2906 ----+-----+-----+----
2907 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002908
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029114.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2912--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002914The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2915limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2916they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2917limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002918marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002919option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002920and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2921with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2922specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002924
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002925 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2926------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2927acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928backlog X X X -
2929balance X - X X
2930bind - X X -
2931bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002932capture cookie - X X -
2933capture request header - X X -
2934capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002935clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2936clitcpka-idle X X X -
2937clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002938compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002939cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002940declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941default-server X - X X
2942default_backend X X X -
2943description - X X X
2944disabled X X X X
2945dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002946email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002947email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002948email-alert mailers X X X X
2949email-alert myhostname X X X X
2950email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002951enabled X X X X
2952errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002953errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002954errorloc X X X X
2955errorloc302 X X X X
2956-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2957errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002958force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002959filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002960fullconn X - X X
2961grace X X X X
2962hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002963http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002964http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002965http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002966http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002967http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002968http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002969http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002970http-check set-var X - X X
2971http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002972http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002973http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002974http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002975http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002976http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002977id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002978ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002979load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002980log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002981log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002982log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002983log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002984max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002985maxconn X X X -
2986mode X X X X
2987monitor fail - X X -
2988monitor-net X X X -
2989monitor-uri X X X -
2990option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2991option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2992option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2993option allbackups (*) X - X X
2994option checkcache (*) X - X X
2995option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2996option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002997option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002998option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2999option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003000-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3001option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003002option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3003option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003004option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003005option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003006option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003007option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003008option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003009option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3010option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3011option httpchk X - X X
3012option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003013option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003014option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003015option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003016option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003017option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003018option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3019option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3020option logasap (*) X X X -
3021option mysql-check X - X X
3022option nolinger (*) X X X X
3023option originalto X X X X
3024option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003025option pgsql-check X - X X
3026option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003027option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003028option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003029option smtpchk X - X X
3030option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3031option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3032option splice-request (*) X X X X
3033option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003034option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003035option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3036option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3037-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003038option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003039option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3040option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3041option tcpka X X X X
3042option tcplog X X X X
3043option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003044external-check command X - X X
3045external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003046persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3047rate-limit sessions X X X -
3048redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003049-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003050retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003051retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003052server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003053server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003054server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003055source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003056srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3057srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3058srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003059stats admin - X X X
3060stats auth X X X X
3061stats enable X X X X
3062stats hide-version X X X X
3063stats http-request - X X X
3064stats realm X X X X
3065stats refresh X X X X
3066stats scope X X X X
3067stats show-desc X X X X
3068stats show-legends X X X X
3069stats show-node X X X X
3070stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003071-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3072stick match - - X X
3073stick on - - X X
3074stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003075stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003076stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003077tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003078tcp-check connect X - X X
3079tcp-check expect X - X X
3080tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003081tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003082tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003083tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003084tcp-check set-var X - X X
3085tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003086tcp-request connection - X X -
3087tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003088tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003089tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003090tcp-response content - - X X
3091tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003092timeout check X - X X
3093timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003094timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003095timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003096timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3097timeout http-request X X X X
3098timeout queue X - X X
3099timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003100timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003101timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003102timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003103transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003104unique-id-format X X X -
3105unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003106use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003107use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003108use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003109------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3110 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003111
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031134.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3114---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115
3116This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3117
3118
3119acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3120 Declare or complete an access list.
3121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 no | yes | yes | yes
3123 Example:
3124 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3125 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3126 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003128 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129
3130
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003131backlog <conns>
3132 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 yes | yes | yes | no
3135 Arguments :
3136 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3137 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003138 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003139
3140 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3141 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3142 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3143 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3144 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3145 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3146 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3147 backlog parameter.
3148
3149 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3150 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3151 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3152
3153 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3154
3155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003157balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003158 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | no | yes | yes
3161 Arguments :
3162 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3163 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3164 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3165 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3166
3167 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3168 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3169 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3170 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003171 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003172 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003173 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3174 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3175 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3176 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3177 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3178 it, so that you don't worry.
3179
3180 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3181 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3182 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3183 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3184 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3185 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3186 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3187 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003189 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3190 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3191 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3192 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3193 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3194 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3195 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3196 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3197
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003198 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003199 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003200 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3201 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003202 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003203 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3204 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3205 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3206 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3207 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003208 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3209 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3210 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3211 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3212 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3213 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003214
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3216 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3217 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3218 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3219 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3220 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3221 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3222 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003223 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003225 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3226 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3227 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003228
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003229 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3230 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3231 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3232 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3233 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3234 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3235 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3236 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3237 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3238 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3239 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3240 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003242 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003243 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3244 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3245 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3246 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3247 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3248 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3249 URIs start with a leading "/".
3250
3251 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3252 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3253 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3254 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3255
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003256 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3257 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3258 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3259 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003261 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003262 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3263
3264 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003265 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3266 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003267 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3268 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3269 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3270 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003271 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003272 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3273 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003274
3275 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3276 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3277 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3278 server will receive the request.
3279
3280 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3281 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3282 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3283 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3284 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003285 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3286 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3287 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003288
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003289 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3290 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3291 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3292 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3293 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003295 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003296 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3297 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3298 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3299
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003300 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3301 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3302 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3303
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003304 random
3305 random(<draws>)
3306 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003307 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3308 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3309 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3310 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003311 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3312 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3313 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3314 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3315 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3316 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3317 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3318 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3319 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3320 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3321 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3322 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3323 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3324 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3325 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3326 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3327 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3328 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3329 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3330 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003331
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003332 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003333 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003334 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3335 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3336 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3337 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3338 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3339 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003340 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003341 used instead.
3342
3343 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3344 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3345 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3346 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3347
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003348 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3349 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3350 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3351
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003352 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003355 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3356 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003357
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003358 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3359 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3360 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003361
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003362 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003363 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003364 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3365 NTLM relies on.
3366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367 Examples :
3368 balance roundrobin
3369 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003370 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003371 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3372 balance hdr(host)
3373 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003374
3375 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3376 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003378 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003379 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3380 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3381 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003382 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003383
3384 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3385 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3386 defaults to 16 kB.
3387
3388 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3389 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3390
3391 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3392 Round Robin.
3393
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003394 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003395 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3396 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3397 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3398
3399 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3400
3401 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003402 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003403 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3404 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3405 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003407 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
3409
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003410bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3411bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003412 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 no | yes | yes | no
3415 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003416 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3417 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3418 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3419 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003420 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003421 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3422 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3423 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3424 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3425 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3426 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003427 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003428 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3429 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003430 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003431 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3432 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003433 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003434 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3435 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003436 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003437 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3438 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3439 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3440 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3441 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3442 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3443 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003444 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3445 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3446 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003447 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3448 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3449 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3450 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003451 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3452 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3453 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003454
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003455 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3456 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003457 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3458 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3459 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003460 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3461 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3462 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3463 the range.
3464
3465 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3466 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3467 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3468 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3469 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3470 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3471 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003472 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003473 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003475 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003476 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003477 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3478 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3479 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3480 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3481 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3482 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3483
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003484 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3485 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3486 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3487 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3490 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3491 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3492 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3493 in a frontend.
3494
3495 Example :
3496 listen http_proxy
3497 bind :80,:443
3498 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003499 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003501 listen http_https_proxy
3502 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003503 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003504
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003505 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3506 bind ipv6@:80
3507 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3508 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3509
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003510 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003511 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003512
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003513 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3514 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3515 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3516 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3517 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3518
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003519 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003520 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521
3522
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003523bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003524 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | yes | yes | yes
3527 Arguments :
3528 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3529 may be used to override a default value.
3530
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003531 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003532 option may be combined with other numbers.
3533
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003534 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003535 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3536 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3537 missing from all processes.
3538
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003539 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003540 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003541 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3542 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3543 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3544 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3545 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003546 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003547
3548 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3549 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3550 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3551 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3552 and 'even' instances.
3553
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003554 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3555 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3556 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3557 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003558
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003559 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3560 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3561
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003562 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3563 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3564 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3565
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003566 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3567 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3568
3569 Example :
3570 listen app_ip1
3571 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003572 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003573
3574 listen app_ip2
3575 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003576 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003577
3578 listen management
3579 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003580 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003581
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003582 listen management
3583 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3584 bind-process 1-4
3585
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003586 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003587
3588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589capture cookie <name> len <length>
3590 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 no | yes | yes | no
3593 Arguments :
3594 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3595 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3596 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3597 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003598 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003599
3600 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3601 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3602 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3603 right if it exceeds <length>.
3604
3605 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3606 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3607 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3608 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3609
3610 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3611 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3612 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3613
3614 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3615 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3616 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003617 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3618 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3619 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620
3621 Example:
3622 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3623
3624 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003625 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626
3627
3628capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003629 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3631 no | yes | yes | no
3632 Arguments :
3633 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003634 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3636 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3637 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3638
3639 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3640 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3641 it exceeds <length>.
3642
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003643 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003644 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3645 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003646 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3647 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3648 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3649 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003650 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003651 environments to find where the request came from.
3652
3653 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3654 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3655 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3656 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003657
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003658 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3659 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3660 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3661 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3662 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003663
3664 Example:
3665 capture request header Host len 15
3666 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003667 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003669 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670 about logging.
3671
3672
3673capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003674 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3676 no | yes | yes | no
3677 Arguments :
3678 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003679 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3681 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3682 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3683
3684 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3685 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3686 it exceeds <length>.
3687
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003688 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3690 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3691 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003692 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3693 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3694 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3695 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003697 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3698 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3699 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3700 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3701 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003702
3703 Example:
3704 capture response header Content-length len 9
3705 capture response header Location len 15
3706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003707 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708 about logging.
3709
3710
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003711clitcpka-cnt <count>
3712 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3713 the connection on the client side.
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | no
3716 Arguments :
3717 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3718
3719 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3720 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003721 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3722 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003723
3724 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3725
3726
3727clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3728 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3729 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3730 client side.
3731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3732 yes | yes | yes | no
3733 Arguments :
3734 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3735 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3736 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3737 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3738
3739 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3740 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003741 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3742 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003743
3744 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3745
3746
3747clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3748 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3750 yes | yes | yes | no
3751 Arguments :
3752 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3753 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3754 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3755 document.
3756
3757 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3758 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003759 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3760 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003761
3762 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3763
3764
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003765compression algo <algorithm> ...
3766compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003767compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003768 Enable HTTP compression.
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003772 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3773 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3774 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3775
3776 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003777 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3778 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3779 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003780
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003781 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003782 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003783
3784 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3785 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3786 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3787 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3788 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003789 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003790
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003791 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3792 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3793 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3794 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3795 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3796 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3797 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003798 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003799
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003800 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003801 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003802 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3803 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3804 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3805 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3806 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003807
3808 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3809 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3810 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3811 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3812 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003813 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3814 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3815 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3816 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3817 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003818 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3819 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003820
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003821 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003822 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3823 "Accept-Encoding" header
3824 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003825 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003826 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3827 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3828 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3829 "multipart"
3830 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3831 header
3832 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3833 and later
3834 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3835 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003836 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003837
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003838 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003839
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003840 Examples :
3841 compression algo gzip
3842 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003844
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003845cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003846 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3847 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003848 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003849 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | no | yes | yes
3852 Arguments :
3853 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3854 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3855 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3856 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3857 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3858 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003859 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003860 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3861 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3862
3863 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3864 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3865 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3866 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3867 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3868 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003869 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3870 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003871 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003872 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3873 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874
3875 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003876 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003877
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003878 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003879 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003880 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003881 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003882 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3883 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3884 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3885 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3886 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3887 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3888 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003889
3890 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3891 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3892 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3893 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3894 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3895 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3896 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3897 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3898 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003899 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003900 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3901 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3902 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003903
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003904 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3905 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3906 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003907 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3908 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3909 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3910 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003911 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3912 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3913 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914
3915 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3916 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3917 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3918 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3919 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3920 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3921 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3922 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3923 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3924
3925 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3926 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3927 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3928 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3929 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3930 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3931 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3932 persistence cookie in the cache.
3933 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3934
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003935 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3936 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3937 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3938 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3939 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003940 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003941 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3942 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3943 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3944 they logout.
3945
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003946 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3947 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3948 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3949 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3950
3951 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3952 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3953 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3954 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3955 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3956 this attribute.
3957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003958 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003959 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003960 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3961 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3962 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3963 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3964 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3965 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003966
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003967 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3968 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3969 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3970 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3971 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3972 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3973 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3974 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003975 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003976 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3977 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3978 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3979 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3980 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3981 the site.
3982
3983 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3984 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3985 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3986 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3987 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3988 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3989 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3990 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3991 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3992 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3993 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3994 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3995 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003996 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003997 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3998 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3999
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004000 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4001 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4002 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4003 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4004 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4005 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4006
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004007 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4008 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4009 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4010 repeated.
4011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004012 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4013 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4014 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4015 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004017 Examples :
4018 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4019 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4020 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004021 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004022
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004023 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004024
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004025
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004026declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4027 Declares a capture slot.
4028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4029 no | yes | yes | no
4030 Arguments:
4031 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4032
4033 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4034 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4035 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4036 for use in the response.
4037
4038 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004039 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004040 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4041
4042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004043default-server [param*]
4044 Change default options for a server in a backend
4045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4046 yes | no | yes | yes
4047 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004048 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4049 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4050 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4051 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004052
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004053 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004054 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4055
4056 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004057
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004059default_backend <backend>
4060 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4062 yes | yes | yes | no
4063 Arguments :
4064 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4065
4066 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4067 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4068 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4069 will catch all undetermined requests.
4070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004071 Example :
4072
4073 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4074 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4075 default_backend dynamic
4076
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004077 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004079
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004080description <string>
4081 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4083 no | yes | yes | yes
4084 Arguments : string
4085
4086 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4087 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4088 it describes.
4089 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4090
4091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004092disabled
4093 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | yes | yes | yes
4096 Arguments : none
4097
4098 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4099 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4100 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4101 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4102 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4103 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4104 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4105
4106 See also : "enabled"
4107
4108
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004109dispatch <address>:<port>
4110 Set a default server address
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4112 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004113 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004114
4115 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4116 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4117 during start-up.
4118
4119 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4120 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4121 possible with normal servers.
4122
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004123 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004124 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4125 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4126 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4127 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4128
4129 See also : "server"
4130
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004131
4132dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4133 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | no | yes | yes
4136 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4137
4138 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004139 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004140 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4141 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004142 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004143 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004145enabled
4146 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 yes | yes | yes | yes
4149 Arguments : none
4150
4151 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4152 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4153
4154 See also : "disabled"
4155
4156
4157errorfile <code> <file>
4158 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4160 yes | yes | yes | yes
4161 Arguments :
4162 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004163 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004164 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004165
4166 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004167 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004169 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4170 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004171
4172 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4173 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4174 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4175
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004176 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4177
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004178 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4179 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4180 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4181 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4182 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4183 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4184 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4185 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4186 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004188 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4189 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4190 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004191 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004192 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4193
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004194 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004195
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004196 Example :
4197 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004198 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004199 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4200 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4201
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004202
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004203errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4204 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4205 section.
4206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4207 yes | yes | yes | yes
4208 Arguments :
4209 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4210
4211 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004212 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004213 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004214
4215 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4216 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4217 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4218 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4219 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004220 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004221 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4222
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004223 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4224 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004225
4226 Example :
4227 errorfiles generic
4228 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4229
4230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004231errorloc <code> <url>
4232errorloc302 <code> <url>
4233 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4235 yes | yes | yes | yes
4236 Arguments :
4237 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004238 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004239 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004240
4241 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4242 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4243 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4244 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004245 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004246
4247 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4248 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4249 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4250
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004251 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4252
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004253 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4254 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4255 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4256 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004257 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004258 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4259 request.
4260
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004261 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004262
4263
4264errorloc303 <code> <url>
4265 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 yes | yes | yes | yes
4268 Arguments :
4269 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004270 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004271 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004272
4273 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4274 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4275 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4276 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004277 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004278
4279 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4280 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4281 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4282
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004283 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4284
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004285 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4286 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4287 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4288 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004289 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004290
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004291 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004292
4293
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004294email-alert from <emailaddr>
4295 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004296 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4298 yes | yes | yes | yes
4299
4300 Arguments :
4301
4302 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4303
4304 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4305 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4306
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004307 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004308 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4309 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004310
4311
4312email-alert level <level>
4313 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4314 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4316 yes | yes | yes | yes
4317
4318 Arguments :
4319
4320 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4321 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4322 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4323
4324 By default level is alert
4325
4326 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4327 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4328 for the proxy.
4329
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004330 Alerts are sent when :
4331
4332 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4333 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4334 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4335 is notice or lower
4336 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4337 and a health check status update occurs
4338
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004339 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4340 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004341 section 3.6 about mailers.
4342
4343
4344email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4345 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4347 yes | yes | yes | yes
4348
4349 Arguments :
4350
4351 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4352
4353 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4354 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4355
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004356 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4357 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004358
4359
4360email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4361 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4362 mailers.
4363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 yes | yes | yes | yes
4365
4366 Arguments :
4367
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004368 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004369
4370 By default the systems hostname is used.
4371
4372 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4373 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4374 for the proxy.
4375
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004376 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4377 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004378
4379
4380email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004381 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004382 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4383 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4384 yes | yes | yes | yes
4385
4386 Arguments :
4387
4388 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4389
4390 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4391 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4392
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004393 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004394 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4395
4396
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004397force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4398 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004400 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004401
4402 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4403 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4404 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4405 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4406 marked down for maintenance operations.
4407
4408 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4409 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4410 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4411 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4412 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4413 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4414 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4415 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4416 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4417
4418 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4419 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4420 is used.
4421
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004422 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004423 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004424
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004425
4426filter <name> [param*]
4427 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 no | yes | yes | yes
4430 Arguments :
4431 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4432 referenced in section 9.
4433
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004434 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004435 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004436 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4437 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004438
4439 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4440 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4441
4442 Example:
4443 listen
4444 bind *:80
4445
4446 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4447 filter compression
4448 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4449
4450 compression algo gzip
4451 compression offload
4452
4453 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4454
4455 See also : section 9.
4456
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004457
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004458fullconn <conns>
4459 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | no | yes | yes
4462 Arguments :
4463 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4464 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4465
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004466 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004467 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004468 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004469 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4470 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4471 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4472 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4473 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004474 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004475
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004476 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4477 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004478 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4479 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4480 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004481
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004482 Example :
4483 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4484 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4485 # connections.
4486 backend dynamic
4487 fullconn 10000
4488 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4489 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4490
4491 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4492
4493
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004494grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004495 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004497 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004498 Arguments :
4499 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4500 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4501 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4502
4503 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4504 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004505 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004506 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4507
4508 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4509 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4510 simplify it.
4511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004513hash-balance-factor <factor>
4514 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4516 yes | no | no | yes
4517 Arguments :
4518 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4519 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004520 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004521
4522 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4523 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4524 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4525 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4526 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4527 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4528 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4529
4530 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4531 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4532 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4533 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4534 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4535
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004536 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4537 consistent hashing mechanism.
4538
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004539 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4540
4541
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004542hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004543 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4545 yes | no | yes | yes
4546 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004547 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4548 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004549
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004550 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4551 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4552 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4553 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4554 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4555 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4556 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4557 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4558 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4559 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004560
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004561 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4562 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4563 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4564 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4565 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4566 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4567 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4568 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4569 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4570 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4571 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4572 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4573 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004574 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4575 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004576
4577 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4578
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004579 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004580 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4581 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4582 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004583 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4584 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4585 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004586
4587 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4588 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004589 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4590 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4591 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4592 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4593
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004594 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4595 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4596 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4597 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4598 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4599 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4600 parameter.
4601
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004602 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4603 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4604 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4605 used on strings.
4606
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004607 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4608
4609 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4610 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4611 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4612 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4613 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4614 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4615 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4616 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4617 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4618 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4619 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4620 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004621
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004622 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4623 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4624 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004625
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004626 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004627
4628
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004629http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4630 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4631 ones).
4632
4633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 no | yes | yes | yes
4635
4636 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4637 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4638 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4639 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4640 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4641 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4642
4643 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4644 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4645 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4646
4647 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4648 below.
4649
4650 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4651 instance.
4652
4653 Example:
4654 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4655 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4656 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4657
4658http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4659
4660 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4661 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4662 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4663 example, or to pass some internal information.
4664 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4665 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4666 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4667
4668http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4669
4670 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4671 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4672
4673http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4674
4675 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4676
4677http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4679
4680 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4681
4682 Example:
4683 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4684
4685 # applied to:
4686 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4687
4688 # outputs:
4689 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4690
4691 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4692
4693http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4694 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4695
4696 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4697
4698 Example:
4699 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4700
4701 # applied to:
4702 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4703
4704 # outputs:
4705 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4706
4707http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4708
4709 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4710 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4711 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4712
4713http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4714 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4715
4716 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4717 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4718 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4719 fallback.
4720
4721 Example:
4722 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4723 http-response set-status 431
4724 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4725 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4726
4727http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4728
4729 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4730 inline.
4731
4732 Arguments:
4733 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4734 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4735 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4736 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4737 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4738 (request and response)
4739 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4740 processing
4741 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4742 processing
4743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4744 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4745 and '_'.
4746
4747 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4748 followed by some converters.
4749
4750 Example:
4751 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4752
4753http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4754
4755 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4756 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4757 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4758 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4759 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004760 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004761 processing.
4762
4763 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4764 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004765 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004766 rules evaluation.
4767
4768http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4769
4770 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4771 details about <var-name>.
4772
4773 Example:
4774 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4775
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004776
4777http-check comment <string>
4778 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4779 it fails.
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | no | yes | yes
4782
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004783 Arguments :
4784 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4785 rule fails.
4786
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004787 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4788 user-friendly error reporting.
4789
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004790 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004791 "http-check expect".
4792
4793
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004794http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4795 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004796 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004797 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4799 yes | no | yes | yes
4800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004801 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004802 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4803
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004804 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004805 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004806
4807 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4808 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4809 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4810 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4811
4812 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4813
4814 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4815
4816 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4817
4818 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4819
4820 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4821
4822 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4823 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4824 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4825 is used.
4826
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004827 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4828 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4829 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4830 haproxy -vv.
4831
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004832 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4833
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004834 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4835 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4836 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4837 different ports or with different servers.
4838
4839 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4840 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4841 the port with a "http-check connect".
4842
4843 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4844 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4845 do.
4846
4847 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4848 unset-var or comment rules.
4849
4850 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004851 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4852 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4853 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4854 option httpchk
4855
4856 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004857 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004858 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004859 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004860 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004861 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004862
4863 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4864
4865 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004866
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004868http-check disable-on-404
4869 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004871 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004872 Arguments : none
4873
4874 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4875 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4876 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4877 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4878 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4879 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4880 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4881 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004882 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4883 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4884 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4885
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004886 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004887
4888
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004889http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004890 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4891 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4892 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004893 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004895 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004896
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004897 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004898 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4899
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004900 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4901 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4902 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4903 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4904 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4905 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4906 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4907 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4908 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4909 result is always conclusive.
4910
4911 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4912 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4913 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004914 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4915 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4916 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4917 example 404 with disable-on-404
4918 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4919 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4920 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004921
4922 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4923 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004924 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4925 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4926 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4927 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4928 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4929 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004930
4931 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4932 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004933 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4934 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4935 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4936 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004937 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4938
4939 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4940 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4941 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4942 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4943
4944 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4945 informational message reported in logs if an error
4946 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4947 log-format string.
4948
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004949 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004950 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4951 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004952 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4953 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4954 details on the supported keywords.
4955
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004956 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4957 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4958 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4959 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004960
4961 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4962 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4963 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4964 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4965 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4966
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004967 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4968 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4969 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4970 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4971 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4972 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4973 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004974
4975 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004976 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004977 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4978 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4979 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4980 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4981
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004982 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4983 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004984 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4985 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4986 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4987 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4988 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4989 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4990 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4991 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004992 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4993 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4994 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4995 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4996 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4997 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4998 insensitive on the header names.
4999
5000 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5001 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5002 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5003 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5004 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5005 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005006
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005007 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005008 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005009 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5010 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5011 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5012 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5013 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005014 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005015 trace).
5016
5017 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005018 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005019 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5020 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5021 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5022 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5023 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005024 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005025
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005026 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5027 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5028 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5029 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5030 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5031 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5032
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005033 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5034 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5035 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5036 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5037 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5038 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5039 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5040 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5041
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005042 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5043 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5044 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5045 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5046 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005047
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005048 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5049 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5050
5051 Examples :
5052 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005053 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005054
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005055 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5056 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5057
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005058 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005059 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005060
5061 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005062 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005063
5064 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005065 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005066
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005067 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005068 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005069
5070
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005071http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005072 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5073 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005074 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5075 health checks.
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 yes | no | yes | yes
5078 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005079 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5080
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005081 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5082 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5083 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5084 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5085 to invent non-standard ones.
5086
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005087 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5088 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5089 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5090 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5091
5092 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5093 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5094 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5095 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005096
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005097 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005098 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005099 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005100 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5101 to add it.
5102
5103 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5104 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5105 to the log-format rules.
5106
5107 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5108 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5109 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005110
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005111 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5112 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5113 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5114 request.
5115
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005116 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5117 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5118 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005119 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5120 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5121 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5122 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005123 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005124 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005125 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5126
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005127 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5128 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005129 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5130 so, it will be ignored.
5131
5132 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5133 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5134 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5135 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5136 configured request authority.
5137
5138 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5139 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005140
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005141 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005142
5143
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005144http-check send-state
5145 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5147 yes | no | yes | yes
5148 Arguments : none
5149
5150 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5151 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5152 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5153 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5154 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5155
5156 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5157 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5158 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5159 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5160 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005161 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5162 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5163 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5164
5165 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5166 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5167 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5168
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005169 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5170 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5171 checked in multiple backends.
5172
5173 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5174 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5175
5176 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5177 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5178 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5179 one fails.
5180
5181 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5182 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5183 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5184
5185 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5186 server's queue.
5187
5188 Example of a header received by the application server :
5189 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5190 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5191
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005192 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5193 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005194
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005195
5196http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005197 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 yes | no | yes | yes
5200
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005201 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005202 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5203 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5204 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5205 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5206 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5207 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5208 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5209 and '-'.
5210
5211 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5212
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005213 Examples :
5214 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005215
5216
5217http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005218 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 yes | no | yes | yes
5221
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005222 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005223 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5224 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5227 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5229 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5230 and '-'.
5231
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005232 Examples :
5233 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005235
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005236http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5237 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5238 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5239 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5240 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 yes | yes | yes | yes
5243 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005244 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005245 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005246 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5247 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005248
5249 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5250 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5251 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5252 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5253
5254 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5255 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5256 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5257 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5258
5259 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5260 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5261 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5262 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5263 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5264 chroot is performed.
5265
5266 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5267 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5268 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5269 considered.
5270
5271 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5272 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5273 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5274 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5275 considered as a raw string.
5276
5277 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5278 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5279 "content-type".
5280
5281 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5282 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5283 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5284 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5285 evaluated as a log-format string.
5286
5287 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5288 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5289 argument to "content-type".
5290
5291 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5292 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5293 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5294 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5295
5296 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5297 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5298 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5299 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5300 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5301 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5302 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5303 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5304
5305 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5306 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5307 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5308
5309 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5310 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5311
5312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005313http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005314 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5315
5316 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5317 no | yes | yes | yes
5318
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005319 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5320 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5321 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5322 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5323 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005325 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5326 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005328 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005330 Example:
5331 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5332 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5333 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005335 http-request allow if nagios
5336 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5337 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5338 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005340 Example:
5341 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5342 acl add path /addacl
5343 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005345 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005347 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5348 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005350 Example:
5351 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5352 acl setmap path /setmap
5353 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005355 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5358 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005360 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5361 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005363http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005365 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5366 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5367 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5368 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5369 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5370 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5371 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5372 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005374http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005376 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5377 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5378 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5379 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5380 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5381 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5382 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5383 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005385http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005387 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5388 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005389
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005391http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005393 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5394 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5395 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5396 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5397 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005398
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005399 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5400 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5401 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5402 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5403 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5404 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5405 instead.
5406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005407 Example:
5408 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5409 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005410
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005411http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005412
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005413 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005415http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5416 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005418 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5419 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5420 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5421 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5422 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5423 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5424 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5425 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5426 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005428 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5429 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5430 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005431 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5432
5433 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5434 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5435 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5436 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005438http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005440 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5441 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5442 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5443 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5444 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5445 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005447http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005449 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005450
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005451http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005453 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5454 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5455 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5456 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5457 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5458 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005459
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005460http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5461http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5462 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5463 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5464 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5465 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005466
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005467 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5468 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5469 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005470 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005471 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5472 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5473 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005474 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005475 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005476
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005477http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5478 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5479 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5480 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5481
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005482http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5483
5484 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5485 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5486 pointed by <resolvers>.
5487 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5488 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5489 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5490 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5491 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5492 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5493 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5494 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5495 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5496 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5497 to 0.0.0.0.
5498
5499 Example:
5500 resolvers mydns
5501 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5502 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5503 timeout retry 1s
5504 hold valid 10s
5505 hold nx 3s
5506 hold other 3s
5507 hold obsolete 0s
5508 accepted_payload_size 8192
5509
5510 frontend fe
5511 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5512 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5513 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5514
5515 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5516 # which mean DNS resolution error
5517 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5518
5519 default_backend be
5520
5521 backend b_503
5522 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5523 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5524 # 503 error page to end users
5525
5526 backend be
5527 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5528 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5529 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5530 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5531 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5532
5533 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5534 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5535
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005536http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5537
5538 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5539 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5540 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5541 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005542 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5543 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005544
5545 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005547http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005549 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5550 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5551 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5552 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5553 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005555http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005557 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5558 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5559 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5560 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005562http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005564
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005565 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005566 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5567 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5568 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5569 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5570 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005571
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005572 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5573 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5574 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5575 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5576 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005577
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005578 Example:
5579 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5580
5581 # applied to:
5582 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5583
5584 # outputs:
5585 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5586
5587 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005588
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005589 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5590
5591 # applied to:
5592 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005593
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005594 # outputs:
5595 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005596
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005597http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5598 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5599
5600 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5601 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005602 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5603 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5604 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005605
5606 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5607 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5608 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5609
5610 Example:
5611 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5612 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5613
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005614 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5615 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5616 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5617 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5618
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005619http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5620 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5621
5622 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5623 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5624 query-string are replaced.
5625
5626 Example:
5627 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5628 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5629
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005630http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5631 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5632
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005633 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5634 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5635 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5636 against.
5637
5638 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5639 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5640 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005641
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005642 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5643 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5644 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5645 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5646 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5647 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5648 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5649 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5650 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005651 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5652 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005653
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005654 Example:
5655 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5656 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005657
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005658 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5659 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005661http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5662 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005663
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005664 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5665 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5666 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5667 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005668
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005669 Example:
5670 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005671
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005672 # applied to:
5673 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005674
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005675 # outputs:
5676 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005677
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005678http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5679 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5680 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005681 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005682 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5683
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005684 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005685 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5686 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005687 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005688 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005689 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005690 are followed to create the response :
5691
5692 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5693 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5694 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5695 ignored.
5696
5697 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5698 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005699 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005700 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5701 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005702
5703 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5704 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5705 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005706 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005707 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005708
5709 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5710 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5711 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005712 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005713 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5714 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005715
5716 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5717 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5718 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5719 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5720 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5721 as a raw content.
5722
5723 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5724 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5725 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5726 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5727 considered as a raw string.
5728
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005729 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005730 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5731 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5732 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5733
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005734 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5735 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005736 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005737
5738 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5739
5740 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005741 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005742 if { path /ping }
5743
5744 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5745 if { path /favicon.ico }
5746
5747 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5748 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5749 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005751http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5752http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005754 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5755 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5756 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005757
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005758http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5759 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005760
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005761 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5762 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5763 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5764 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005766http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005768 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5769 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5770 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5771 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5772 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005774 Arguments:
5775 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5776 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005778 Example:
5779 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5780 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005782 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5783 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005785http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005786
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005787 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5788 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5789 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791 Arguments:
5792 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5793 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005795 Example:
5796 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5797 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5800 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5801 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005805 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5806 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5807 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5808 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5809 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811 Example:
5812 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5813 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5814 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5815 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5816 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5817 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5818 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5819 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5820 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5825 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5826 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5827 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5828 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005830http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5831 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005833 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5834 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5835 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5836 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5837 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5838 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5839 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5840 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5841 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005843http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005845 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5846 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5847 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5848 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5849 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5850 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5851 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005853http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5856 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5857 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005859http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005861 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5862 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5863 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5864 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5865 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5866 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5867 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5868 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005872 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5873 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5874 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5875 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5876 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5877 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005879 Example :
5880 # prepend the host name before the path
5881 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005882
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005883http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5884
5885 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5886 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5887 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005889http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5892 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5893 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5894 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5895 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005897http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005899 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5900 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5901 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5902 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5903 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5904 values have higher priority.
5905 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5906 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5907 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5908 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5909 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005913 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5914 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5915 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5916 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5917 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5918 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5919 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005921 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005922
5923 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5925 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005927http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5928 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5929 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5930 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005931 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5932 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005933
5934 Arguments :
5935 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5936 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005937
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005938 See also "option forwardfor".
5939
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005940 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5942 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5943
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005944 # After the masking this will track connections
5945 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5946 http-request track-sc0 src
5947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005948 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5949 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5950
5951http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5952
5953 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5954 expression.
5955
5956 Arguments:
5957 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5958 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005959
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005960 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005961 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5962 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5963
5964 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5965 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5966 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5967
5968http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5969
5970 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5971 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5972 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5973 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5974 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5975 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5976 information from the request.
5977
5978 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5979
5980http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5981
5982 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5983 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5984 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5985 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5986 path and the query string.
5987 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5988
5989http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5990
5991 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5992 inline.
5993
5994 Arguments:
5995 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5996 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5997 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5998 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5999 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6000 (request and response)
6001 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6002 processing
6003 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6004 processing
6005 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6006 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6007 and '_'.
6008
6009 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6010 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006011
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006012 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006015http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6019 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6020 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6021 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6022 agent name must be used.
6023
6024 Arguments:
6025 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6026
6027 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6028 configuration.
6029
6030http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6031
6032 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6033 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6034 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6035 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6036 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6037 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6038 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6039 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6040 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6041 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6042 action.
6043 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6044 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6045 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6046 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6047 you fully understand how it works.
6048
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006049http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6050
6051 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6052 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6053 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6054 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6055 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006056 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006057 processing.
6058
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006059 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006060 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6061 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6062 rules evaluation.
6063
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006064http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6065http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6066 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6067 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6068 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6069 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070
6071 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6072 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6073 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006074 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6075 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6076 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6077 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6078 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6079 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6080 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6081 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6082 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6083 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006084 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006085 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6086 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6087 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6088 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6089 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090
6091http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6092http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6093http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6094
6095 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6096 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6097 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6098 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
6099 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
6100 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6101 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6102 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6103 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6104 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6105 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6106 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6107
6108 Arguments :
6109 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6110 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6111 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6112 select which table entry to update the counters.
6113
6114 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6115 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6116 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6117 that table until the session ends.
6118
6119 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6120 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6121 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6122 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6123 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6124 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6125 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6126 useful information.
6127
6128 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6129 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6130 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6131 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6132 checks that make use of it.
6133
6134http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6135
6136 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006137
6138 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006139 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006140
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006141http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6142
6143 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6144 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6145 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6146 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6147 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6148 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6149
6150 Arguments :
6151 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6152
6153 Example:
6154 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006158 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6159 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6160 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006161
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006163http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006164 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6165
6166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 no | yes | yes | yes
6168
6169 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6170 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6171 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6172 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6173 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6174 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006176 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6177 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006179 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006181 Example:
6182 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006184 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006186 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6187 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006189 Example:
6190 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006191
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006192 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006194 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6195 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006197 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6198 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006200http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006202 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6203 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6204 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6205 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6206 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6207 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6208 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6209 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006211http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006213 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6214 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6215 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6216 example, or to pass some internal information.
6217 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6218 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6219 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006221http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006223 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6224 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006225
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006226http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006227
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006228 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006229
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006230http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006231
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006232 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6233 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6234 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6235 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6236 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6237 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6238 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006240 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6241 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6242 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6243 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6244 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006245
6246 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6247 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6248 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6249 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006251http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006252
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006253 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6254 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6255 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6256 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6257 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6258 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006259
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006260http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006261
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006262 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006263
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006264http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006265
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006266 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6267 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6268 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6269 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6270 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6271 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006272
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006273http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6274http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6275 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6276 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6277 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6278 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006279
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006280 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6281 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6282 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006283 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006284 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6285 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6286 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006287 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006288 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006289
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006290http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006291
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006292 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6293 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6294 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6295 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6296 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6297 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006299http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6300 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006301
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006302 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6303 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006305 Example:
6306 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006307
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006308 # applied to:
6309 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006311 # outputs:
6312 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006314 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006316http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6317 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006318
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006319 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006320 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006322 Example:
6323 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006325 # applied to:
6326 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006327
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006328 # outputs:
6329 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006330
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006331http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6332 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6333 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006334 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6336
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006337 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006338 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6339 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006340 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006341 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006342 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006343 are followed to create the response :
6344
6345 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6346 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6347 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6348 ignored.
6349
6350 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6351 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006352 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006353 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6354 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006355
6356 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6357 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6358 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006359 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006360 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006361
6362 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6363 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6364 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006365 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006366 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6367 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006368
6369 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6370 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6371 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6372 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6373 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6374 as a raw content.
6375
6376 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6377 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6378 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6379 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6380 considered as a raw string.
6381
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006382 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6383 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6384 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6385 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6386
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006387 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6388 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006389 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006390
6391 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6392
6393 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006394 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006395 if { status eq 404 }
6396
6397 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6398 string "This is the end !" \
6399 if { status eq 500 }
6400
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006401http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6402http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006403
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006404 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6405 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6406 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006407
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006408http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6409 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006410
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006411 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6412 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6413 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6414 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006415
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006416http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006418 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6419 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6420 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6421 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6422 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006424 Arguments:
6425 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006427 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6428 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006430http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006432 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6433 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6434 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006436http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6437
6438 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6439 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6440 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6441 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6442 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6443
6444http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6445
6446 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6447 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6448 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6449 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6450 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6451 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6452 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6453 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6454 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6455
6456http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6457
6458 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6459 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6460 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6461 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6462 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6463 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6464 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6465
6466http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6467
6468 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6469 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6470 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6471 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6472 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6473 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6474 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6475 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6476
6477http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479
6480 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6481 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6482 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6483 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006484
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006485 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006486 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6487 http-response set-status 431
6488 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6489 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006491http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006492
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006493 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6494 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6495 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6496 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6497 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6498 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6499 based on some information from the request.
6500
6501 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6502
6503http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6504
6505 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6506 inline.
6507
6508 Arguments:
6509 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6510 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6511 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6512 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6513 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6514 (request and response)
6515 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6516 processing
6517 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6518 processing
6519 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6520 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6521 and '_'.
6522
6523 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6524 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006525
6526 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006527 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006528
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006529http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006530
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006531 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6532 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6533 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6534 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6535 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6536 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6537 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6538 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6539 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6540 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6541 action.
6542 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6543 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6544 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6545 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6546 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006547
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006548http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6549
6550 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6551 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6552 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6553 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6554 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006555 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006556 processing.
6557
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006558 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006559 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006560 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006561 rules evaluation.
6562
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006563http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6564http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6565http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006566
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006567 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6568 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6569 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6570 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6571 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6572 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6573
6574http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6575
6576 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6577 about <var-name>.
6578
6579 Example:
6580 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6581
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006582
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006583http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6584 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6585
6586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | no | yes | yes
6588
6589 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006590 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6591 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6592 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006593
6594 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6595
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006596 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6597 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6598 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6599 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6600 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6601 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6602 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6603 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6604 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6605 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006606
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006607 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6608 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6609 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6610 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6611 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6612 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6613 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006614 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6615 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6616 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6617 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6618 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6619 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006620
6621 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6622 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6623 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6624 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6625 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6626 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6627 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6628 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006629 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006630 downsides of rare connection failures.
6631
6632 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6633 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6634 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6635 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6636 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6637 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006638 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006639 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6640 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6641 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6642 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6643 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6644
6645 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006646 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6647 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6648 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006649
6650 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006651 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006652
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006653 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6654 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006655
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006656 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006657
6658 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6659 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6660 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6661
6662 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6663
6664
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006665http-send-name-header [<header>]
6666 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006669 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006670 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6671
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006672 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6673 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6674 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6675 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6676 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6677 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6678 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6679 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6680 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6681 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6682 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6683 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6684 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6685 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6686 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6687 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006688
6689 See also : "server"
6690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006691id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006692 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 no | yes | yes | yes
6695 Arguments : none
6696
6697 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6698 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6699 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006700
6701
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006702ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6703 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006705 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006706
6707 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6708 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6709 and running).
6710
6711 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6712 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6713 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006714 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006715 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6716
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006717 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6718 "unless" condition is met.
6719
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006720 Example:
6721 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6722 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6723 ignore-persist if url_static
6724
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006725 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6726
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006727load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6728 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6730 yes | no | yes | yes
6731
6732 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6733 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6734 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006735 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006736 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6737 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6738 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6739 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6740
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006741 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006742 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006743 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006744
6745 Arguments:
6746 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6747 named "server-state-file".
6748
6749 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6750 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6751 name is used as a file name.
6752
6753 none don't load any stat for this backend
6754
6755 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006756 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6757 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6758 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006759 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006760 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006761
6762 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6763 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6764
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006765 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006766
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006767 global
6768 stats socket /tmp/socket
6769 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006770
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006771 defaults
6772 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006773
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006774 backend bk
6775 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6776 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006777
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006778
6779 Then one can run :
6780
6781 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6782
6783 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6784
6785 1
6786 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6787 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6788 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6789
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006790 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006791
6792 global
6793 stats socket /tmp/socket
6794 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6795
6796 defaults
6797 load-server-state-from-file local
6798
6799 backend bk
6800 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6801 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6802
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006803
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006804 Then one can run :
6805
6806 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6807
6808 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6809
6810 1
6811 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6812 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6813 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6814
6815 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6816 "show servers state"
6817
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006818
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006819log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006820log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6821 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006822no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006823 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6825 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006826
6827 Prefix :
6828 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6829 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6830 prefix does not allow arguments.
6831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006832 Arguments :
6833 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6834 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6835 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6836 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6837 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6838 parameter.
6839
6840 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6841 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6842
6843 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6844 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6845 standard syslog port).
6846
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006847 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6848 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6849 standard syslog port).
6850
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006851 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6852 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6853 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006854 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006855
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006856 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6857 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6858 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6859 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6860 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6861 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6862 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6863 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6864 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6865 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6866 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6867 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6868 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6869 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6870 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6871 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006872 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6873 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006874
6875 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6876 and "fd@2", see above.
6877
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006878 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6879 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6880 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6881 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6882 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6883 having the logs instantly available.
6884
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006885 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6886 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006887
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006888 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6889 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6890 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6891 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6892 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6893 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6894 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6895 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6896 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6897 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006898 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006899
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006900 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6901 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6902 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6903 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6904 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6905
6906 <sample_size>
6907 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6908 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6909 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6910 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6911 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6912
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006913 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6914 one of the following :
6915
6916 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6917 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6918
6919 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6920 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6921
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006922 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6923 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6924 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6925 designed to be used with a local log server.
6926
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006927 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6928 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6929 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6930 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6931 systemd logger consumes.
6932
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006933 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6934 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6935 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6936 used with a local log server.
6937
6938 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6939 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6940 designed to be used with a local log server.
6941
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006942 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6943 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6944 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6945 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6946
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006947 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6948
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006949 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6950 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6951 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6952
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006953 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6954 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6955 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6956 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006957
6958 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6959 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6960 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006961 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6962 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6963 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6964 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6965 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006966
6967 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6968
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006969 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6970 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6971 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006972
6973 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6974 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6975 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6976 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6977
6978 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6979 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006980
6981 Example :
6982 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006983 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6984 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6985 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006986 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6987 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006988 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006990
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006991log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006992 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006995
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006996 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6997 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6998 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6999 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7000 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007001
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007002 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7003 "option httplog" directives.
7004
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007005log-format-sd <string>
7006 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7008 yes | yes | yes | no
7009
7010 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7011 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7012 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7013 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7014 which covers the log format string in depth.
7015
7016 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7017 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7018
7019 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7020 log format to "rfc5424".
7021
7022 Example :
7023 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7024
7025
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007026log-tag <string>
7027 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7029 yes | yes | yes | yes
7030
7031 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7032 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7033 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7034 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7035 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7036 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7037 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7038 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7039 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007040
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007041max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7042 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7044 yes | no | yes | yes
7045
7046 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7047 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7048 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7049 servers.
7050
7051 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7052 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7053 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7054 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7055 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007056 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007057 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7058 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7059 picking a different server.
7060
7061 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7062 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7063 even if they have to be queued.
7064
7065 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7066 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7067
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007068max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7069 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7070 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7071 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007072
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007073maxconn <conns>
7074 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | yes | yes | no
7077 Arguments :
7078 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7079 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7080 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7081 closes.
7082
7083 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7084 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7085 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7086 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007087 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7088 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7089 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7090 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007091
7092 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7093 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7094 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7095
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007096 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7097 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007098
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007099 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7100
7101
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007102mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007103 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7105 yes | yes | yes | yes
7106 Arguments :
7107 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7108 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7109 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7110 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7111
7112 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7113 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7114 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7115 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7116 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7117
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007118 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7119 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7120 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007121
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007122 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007123 defaults http_instances
7124 mode http
7125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007126
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007127monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007128 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7130 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007131 Arguments :
7132 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7133 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007134 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007135 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7136 backend and its backup.
7137
7138 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7139 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7140 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7141 servers in a list of backends.
7142
7143 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7144 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7145 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7146 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7147 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7148 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7149 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007150 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7151 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007152
7153 Example:
7154 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007155 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007156 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7157 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7158 monitor-uri /site_alive
7159 monitor fail if site_dead
7160
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007161 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007162
7163
7164monitor-net <source>
7165 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
7166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7167 yes | yes | yes | no
7168 Arguments :
7169 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
7170 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
7171 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
7172 followed by a mask.
7173
7174 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
7175 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007176 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007177 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
7178
7179 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
7180 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
7181 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
7182 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007183 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
7184 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
7185 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007186
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007187 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
7188 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
7189 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
7190 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
7191 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
7192 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007193
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01007194 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
7195 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007197 Example :
7198 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
7199 frontend www
7200 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
7201
7202 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
7203
7204
7205monitor-uri <uri>
7206 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7208 yes | yes | yes | no
7209 Arguments :
7210 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7211 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7212
7213 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7214 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7215 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7216 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7217 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7218 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7219 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7220 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7221
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007222 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007223 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7224 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7225 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7226 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7227 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7228 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007229
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007230 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7231 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7232 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7233 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7234
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007235 Example :
7236 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7237 frontend www
7238 mode http
7239 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7240
7241 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007243
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007244option abortonclose
7245no option abortonclose
7246 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7248 yes | no | yes | yes
7249 Arguments : none
7250
7251 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7252 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7253 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7254 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007255 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007256 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7257 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7258 encountered while delivering the response.
7259
7260 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7261 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7262 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7263 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7264 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7265 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007266 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007267 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007268 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007269 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7270 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7271 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7272
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007273 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7274 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007275 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7276 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7277 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7278 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7279 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7280 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007281 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007282
7283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7285
7286 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7287
7288
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007289option accept-invalid-http-request
7290no option accept-invalid-http-request
7291 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | yes | yes | no
7294 Arguments : none
7295
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007296 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007297 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007298 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007299 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7300 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7301 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7302 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7303 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007304 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7305 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7306 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7307 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007308 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007309 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007310 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7311 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7312 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007313
7314 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7315 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7316 been confirmed.
7317
7318 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7319 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007320 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7321 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007322 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7323
7324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7326
7327 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7328 stats socket.
7329
7330
7331option accept-invalid-http-response
7332no option accept-invalid-http-response
7333 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7335 yes | no | yes | yes
7336 Arguments : none
7337
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007338 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007339 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007340 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007341 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7342 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7343 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7344 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7345 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007346 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7347 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7348 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007349
7350 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7351 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7352 been confirmed.
7353
7354 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7355 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7356 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7357 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7358
7359 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7360 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7361
7362 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7363 stats socket.
7364
7365
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007366option allbackups
7367no option allbackups
7368 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7370 yes | no | yes | yes
7371 Arguments : none
7372
7373 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7374 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7375 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7376 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7377 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7378 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7379 order between the backup servers anymore.
7380
7381 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7382 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7383
7384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7386
7387
7388option checkcache
7389no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007390 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 yes | no | yes | yes
7393 Arguments : none
7394
7395 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7396 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007397 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007398 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7399 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007400 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007401
7402 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007403 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007404 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007405 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7406 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007407 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007408 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007409 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7410 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007411 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007412 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7413 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007414 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007415 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7416 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7417 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7418 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7419 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7420 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7421 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7422 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7423 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7424
7425 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007426 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7427 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7428 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7429 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007430
7431 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7432 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007433 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007434 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007435
7436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7438
7439
7440option clitcpka
7441no option clitcpka
7442 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7444 yes | yes | yes | no
7445 Arguments : none
7446
7447 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7448 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007449 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007450 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7451
7452 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7453 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7454 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7455 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7456
7457 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7458 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7459 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7460 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7461 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7462
7463 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7464
7465 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7466 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7467 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7468
7469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7471
7472 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7473
7474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007475option contstats
7476 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7478 yes | yes | yes | no
7479 Arguments : none
7480
7481 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7482 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7483 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7484 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007485 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7486 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7487 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7488 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7489 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007490
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007491option disable-h2-upgrade
7492no option disable-h2-upgrade
7493 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7494 connection.
7495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 yes | yes | yes | no
7497 Arguments : none
7498
7499 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7500 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7501 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7502 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7503 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7504 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7505 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7506 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7507
7508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007510
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007511option dontlog-normal
7512no option dontlog-normal
7513 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 yes | yes | yes | no
7516 Arguments : none
7517
7518 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7519 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7520 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7521 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7522 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7523 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7524 logged.
7525
7526 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7527 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7528 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007530 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007531 logging.
7532
7533
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007534option dontlognull
7535no option dontlognull
7536 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7538 yes | yes | yes | no
7539 Arguments : none
7540
7541 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7542 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7543 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7544 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7545 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7546 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007547 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7548 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7549 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007550
7551 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007552 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007553 would not be logged.
7554
7555 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7556 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7557
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007558 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7559 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007560
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007561
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007562option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007563 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7565 yes | yes | yes | yes
7566 Arguments :
7567 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7568 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007569 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007570 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007571
7572 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7573 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7574 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7575 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7576 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7577 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7578 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007579 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7580 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7581 possible that the client has already brought one.
7582
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007583 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007584 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007585 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007586 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007587 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007588 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007589
7590 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7591 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7592 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7593 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7594 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7595 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7596 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7597
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007598 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7599 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7600 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7601 are under the control of the end-user.
7602
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007603 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007604 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7605 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007606 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7607 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7608 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007609
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007610 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007611 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7612 frontend www
7613 mode http
7614 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7615
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007616 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7617 backend www
7618 mode http
7619 option forwardfor header X-Client
7620
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007621 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007622 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007623
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007624
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007625option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7626no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7627 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7629 yes | yes | yes | no
7630 Arguments : none
7631
7632 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7633 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7634 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7635 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7636 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7637 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7638 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7639
7640 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7641 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7642 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7643 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7644 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7645 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7646 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7647 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7648 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7649 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7650
7651 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7652
7653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7655
7656 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7657 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7658
7659
7660option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7661no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7662 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7664 yes | no | yes | yes
7665 Arguments : none
7666
7667 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7668 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7669 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7670 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7671 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7672 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7673 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7674
7675 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7676 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7677 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7678 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7679 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7680 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7681 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7682 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7683 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7684 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7685
7686 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7687
7688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7690
7691 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7692 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7693
7694
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007695option http-buffer-request
7696no option http-buffer-request
7697 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7699 yes | yes | yes | yes
7700 Arguments : none
7701
7702 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7703 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7704 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7705 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7706 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7707 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007708 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7709 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7710 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7711 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007712
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007713 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007714
7715
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007716option http-ignore-probes
7717no option http-ignore-probes
7718 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7720 yes | yes | yes | no
7721 Arguments : none
7722
7723 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7724 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7725 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7726 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7727 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7728 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7729 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7730 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7731 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007732 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7733 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007734 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7735
7736 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7737 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7738 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7739 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7740 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7741 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7742 are often the only way to detect them.
7743
7744 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7745 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7746
7747 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7748
7749
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007750option http-keep-alive
7751no option http-keep-alive
7752 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7754 yes | yes | yes | yes
7755 Arguments : none
7756
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007757 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7758 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007759 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7760 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007761 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7762 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7763 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007764
7765 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7766 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007767 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7768 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7769 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7770 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7771 situations where this option may be useful :
7772
7773 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007774 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007775
7776 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7777 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7778
7779 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7780 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7781 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7782 request.
7783
7784 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7785 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007786 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7787 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7788 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007789
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007790 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7791 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7792 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7793 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7794 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7795 not set.
7796
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007797 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7798 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7799 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007800
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007801 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007802 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007803 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007804
7805
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007806option http-no-delay
7807no option http-no-delay
7808 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7810 yes | yes | yes | yes
7811 Arguments : none
7812
7813 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7814 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7815 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7816 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7817 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7818 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7819 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7820 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7821 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7822 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7823 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7824 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7825 affected.
7826
7827 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7828 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7829 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7830 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7831 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7832 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7833 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7834 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7835 latency environments.
7836
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007837 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7838
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007839
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007840option http-pretend-keepalive
7841no option http-pretend-keepalive
7842 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007844 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007845 Arguments : none
7846
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007847 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007848 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7849 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7850 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7851 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7852 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7853 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7854 consider the response complete.
7855
7856 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7857 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7858 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7859 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007860 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007861 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7862
7863 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7864 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7865 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7866 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7867 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7868 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7869 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7870
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007871 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7872 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7873 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7874 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7875 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7876 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007877
7878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7880
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007881 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007882 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007883
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007884
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007885option http-server-close
7886no option http-server-close
7887 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7889 yes | yes | yes | yes
7890 Arguments : none
7891
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007892 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7893 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7894 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7895 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007896 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7897 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7898 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7899 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7900 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7901 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7902 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7903 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7904 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7905 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7906 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007907
7908 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7909 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7910 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7911 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007912 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7913 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007914
7915 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7916 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007917 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7918 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7919 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007920
7921 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7922 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7923
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007924 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7925 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007926
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007927option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007928no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007929 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7931 yes | yes | yes | no
7932 Arguments : none
7933
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007934 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007935 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7936 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7937 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7938 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7939 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7940 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7941
7942 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7943 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007944 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7945 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7946 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007947
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007948 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7949 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7950 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7951 front of an existing proxy.
7952
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007953 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7954
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007955 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007956
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007957option httpchk
7958option httpchk <uri>
7959option httpchk <method> <uri>
7960option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007961 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | no | yes | yes
7964 Arguments :
7965 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7966 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7967 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7968 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7969 ones.
7970
7971 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7972 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7973 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7974
7975 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7976 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7977 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007978 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007979
7980 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7981 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7982 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7983 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7984 the lack of any response.
7985
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007986 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7987 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7988 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7989 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7990
7991 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7992 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7993 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007994
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007995 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7996 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007997 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007998 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007999 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008000
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008001 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8002 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8003 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8004 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8005
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008006 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008007 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8008 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8009 backend https_relay
8010 mode tcp
8011 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8012 http-check send hdr Host www
8013 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008014
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008015 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8016 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8017 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008018
8019
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008020option httpclose
8021no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008022 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 yes | yes | yes | yes
8025 Arguments : none
8026
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008027 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8028 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8029 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8030 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008031 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008032
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008033 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8034 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008035 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008036 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8037 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008038
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008039 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8040 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8041 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008042
8043 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8044 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008045 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8046 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8047 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008048
8049 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8050 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8051
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008052 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008053
8054
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008055option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008056 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008058 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008059 Arguments :
8060 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8061 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8062 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008063 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008064 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008065
8066 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8067 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8068 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8069 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8070 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8071 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8072 ports.
8073
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008074 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8075 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008076
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008077 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008079 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008080
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008081
8082option http_proxy
8083no option http_proxy
8084 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 yes | yes | yes | yes
8087 Arguments : none
8088
8089 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8090 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8091 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8092 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8093 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8094
8095 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8096 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008097 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8098 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008099
8100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8102
8103 Example :
8104 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8105 backend direct_forward
8106 option httpclose
8107 option http_proxy
8108
8109 See also : "option httpclose"
8110
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008111
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008112option independent-streams
8113no option independent-streams
8114 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8116 yes | yes | yes | yes
8117 Arguments : none
8118
8119 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8120 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8121 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8122 receive data or not.
8123
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008124 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008125 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8126 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8127 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8128 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8129 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8130 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8131 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8132 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8133 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8134 socket buffers.
8135
8136 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8137 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8138 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8139 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8140 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8141
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008142 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008143
8144
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008145option ldap-check
8146 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8148 yes | no | yes | yes
8149 Arguments : none
8150
8151 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8152 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8153 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8154 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8155
8156 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8157 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8158
8159 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8160 configure it.
8161
8162 Example :
8163 option ldap-check
8164
8165 See also : "option httpchk"
8166
8167
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008168option external-check
8169 Use external processes for server health checks
8170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8171 yes | no | yes | yes
8172
8173 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8174 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8175 command".
8176
8177 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8178
8179 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8180
8181
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008182option log-health-checks
8183no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008184 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8186 yes | no | yes | yes
8187 Arguments : none
8188
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008189 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8190 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8191 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008192
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008193 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8194 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8195 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8196 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8197 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8198
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008199 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008200 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008201
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008202 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8203 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8204 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008205
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008206
8207option log-separate-errors
8208no option log-separate-errors
8209 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8211 yes | yes | yes | no
8212 Arguments : none
8213
8214 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8215 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8216 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8217 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8218 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8219 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8220 provides very important information.
8221
8222 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8223 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8224 error logs.
8225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008226 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008227 logging.
8228
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008229
8230option logasap
8231no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008232 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 yes | yes | yes | no
8235 Arguments : none
8236
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008237 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8238 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8239 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8240 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8241
8242 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8243 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8244 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8245 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8246 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008247 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008248 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8249 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8250 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8251 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008252 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008253
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008254 Examples :
8255 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8256 mode http
8257 option httplog
8258 option logasap
8259 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8260
8261 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8262 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8263 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8264 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008266 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008267 logging.
8268
8269
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008270option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008271 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8273 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008274 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008275 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8276 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008277 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8278 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008279
8280 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8281 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008282 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008283 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8284 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8285 in the MySQL table, like this :
8286
8287 USE mysql;
8288 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8289 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8290
8291 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008292 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008293 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8294 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8295 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8296 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8297 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8298 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8299 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8300
8301 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8302 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008303
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008304 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008305
8306 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8307 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8308 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8309 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008310 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8311 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008312
8313 See also: "option httpchk"
8314
8315
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008316option nolinger
8317no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008318 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8320 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008321 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008322
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008323 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008324 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8325 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8326 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8327 connections.
8328
8329 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8330 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8331 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8332 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8333 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8334 this too.
8335
8336 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8337 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8338 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8339
8340 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8341 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8342 for servers.
8343
8344 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8345 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8346
8347
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008348option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8349 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8351 yes | yes | yes | yes
8352 Arguments :
8353 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8354 matching <network>
8355 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8356 header name.
8357
8358 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8359 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8360 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8361 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8362 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8363 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8364 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8365 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8366 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8367 possible that the client has already brought one.
8368
8369 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8370 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8371 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8372 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8373 header and requires different one.
8374
8375 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8376 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8377 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8378 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8379 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8380 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8381 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8382
8383 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8384 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8385 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8386 both are defined.
8387
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008388 Examples :
8389 # Original Destination address
8390 frontend www
8391 mode http
8392 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8393
8394 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8395 backend www
8396 mode http
8397 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8398
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008399 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008400
8401
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008402option persist
8403no option persist
8404 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8405 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008407 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008408
8409 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8410 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8411 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8412 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8413 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8414 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8415 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8416 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8417 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8418 redirected to another valid server.
8419
8420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8422
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008423 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008424
8425
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008426option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8427 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8429 yes | no | yes | yes
8430 Arguments :
8431 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8432 PostgreSQL server.
8433
8434 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8435 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8436 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8437 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8438
8439 See also: "option httpchk"
8440
8441
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008442option prefer-last-server
8443no option prefer-last-server
8444 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8445 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8446 yes | no | yes | yes
8447 Arguments : none
8448
8449 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8450 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8451 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8452 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8453 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8454 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8455 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8456 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8457 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008458 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8459 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008460 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8461 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8462 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008463 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8464 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8465 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008466
8467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8469
8470 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8471
8472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008473option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008474option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008475no option redispatch
8476 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8478 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008479 Arguments :
8480 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8481 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8482 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008483 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008484 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008485 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008486 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8487 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8488 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008490
8491 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8492 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8493 be able to access the service anymore.
8494
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008495 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8496 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008497
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008498 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8499 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8500 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8501 following order:
8502
8503 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8504
8505 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8506 list, or
8507
8508 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8509
8510 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8511 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8512
8513 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8514 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8515 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8516 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8517
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008518 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008519 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8520 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8524
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008525 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008526
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008527
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008528option redis-check
8529 Use redis health checks for server testing
8530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8531 yes | no | yes | yes
8532 Arguments : none
8533
8534 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8535 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8536 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8537 find the "+PONG" response message.
8538
8539 Example :
8540 option redis-check
8541
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008542 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008543
8544
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008545option smtpchk
8546option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8547 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8549 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008550 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008551 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008552 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008553 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8554
8555 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8556 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8557 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8558
8559 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8560 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8561 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8562 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8563 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8564 dead server.
8565
8566 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8567 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008568 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008569 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8570
8571 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8572 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8573 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8574 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008575 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008576
8577 Example :
8578 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8579
8580 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008583option socket-stats
8584no option socket-stats
8585
8586 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8588 yes | yes | yes | no
8589
8590 Arguments : none
8591
8592
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008593option splice-auto
8594no option splice-auto
8595 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8597 yes | yes | yes | yes
8598 Arguments : none
8599
8600 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8601 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008602 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008603 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008604 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008605 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8606 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8607 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8608 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8609
8610 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8611 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8612 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8613 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8614 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8615 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8616 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8617 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8618 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8619 keyword.
8620
8621 Example :
8622 option splice-auto
8623
8624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8626
8627 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8628 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8629
8630
8631option splice-request
8632no option splice-request
8633 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8635 yes | yes | yes | yes
8636 Arguments : none
8637
8638 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008639 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008640 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8641 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8642 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8643 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8644
8645 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8646
8647 Example :
8648 option splice-request
8649
8650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8652
8653 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8654 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8655
8656
8657option splice-response
8658no option splice-response
8659 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8661 yes | yes | yes | yes
8662 Arguments : none
8663
8664 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008665 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008666 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8667 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8668 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8669 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8670
8671 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8672
8673 Example :
8674 option splice-response
8675
8676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8678
8679 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8680 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8681
8682
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008683option spop-check
8684 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8686 no | no | no | yes
8687 Arguments : none
8688
8689 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8690 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8691 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8692 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8693
8694 Example :
8695 option spop-check
8696
8697 See also : "option httpchk"
8698
8699
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008700option srvtcpka
8701no option srvtcpka
8702 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8704 yes | no | yes | yes
8705 Arguments : none
8706
8707 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8708 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008709 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008710 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8711
8712 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8713 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8714 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8715 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8716
8717 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8718 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8719 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8720 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8721 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8722
8723 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8724
8725 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8726 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8727 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8728
8729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8731
8732 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8733
8734
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008735option ssl-hello-chk
8736 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8738 yes | no | yes | yes
8739 Arguments : none
8740
8741 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8742 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8743 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8744 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8745 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8746 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8747 hello message.
8748
8749 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8750 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8751 messages, which is appreciable.
8752
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008753 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8754 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8755 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008756
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008757 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8758
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008759
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008760option tcp-check
8761 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8763 yes | no | yes | yes
8764
8765 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8766 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8767
8768 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8769 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8770 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008772 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008773 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8774 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8775 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8776 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8777 only.
8778
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008779 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008780 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8781 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8782 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8783 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8784
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008785 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008786 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8787 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008788 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008789 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8790 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8791 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8792 the respective protocols.
8793 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008794 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008795
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008796 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008797
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008798 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8799 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8800 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8801 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008802
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008803 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8804 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8805 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008806
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008807
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008808 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008809 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008810 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008811 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008812
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008813 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008814 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008815 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008816
8817 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8818 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008819 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008820 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008821 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008822 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008823 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008824 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008825 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8826 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008827 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008828 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8829 tcp-check expect string +OK
8830
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008832 (send many headers before analyzing)
8833 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008834 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008835 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8836 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8837 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8838 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008839 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008840
8841
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008842 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008843
8844
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008845option tcp-smart-accept
8846no option tcp-smart-accept
8847 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8849 yes | yes | yes | no
8850 Arguments : none
8851
8852 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8853 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8854 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8855 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8856 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8857 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8858
8859 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8860 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8861 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8862 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8863
8864 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8865 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8866 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008867 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008868
8869 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8870 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8871 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8872
8873 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8874 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8875 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8876
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008877 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8878
8879
8880option tcp-smart-connect
8881no option tcp-smart-connect
8882 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8884 yes | no | yes | yes
8885 Arguments : none
8886
8887 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8888 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8889 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8890 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8891 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8892
8893 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8894 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8895 complex.
8896
8897 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8898 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8899 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8900
8901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8903
8904 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8905
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008906
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008907option tcpka
8908 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8910 yes | yes | yes | yes
8911 Arguments : none
8912
8913 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8914 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008915 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008916 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8917
8918 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8919 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8920 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8921 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8922
8923 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8924 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8925 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8926 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8927 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8928
8929 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8930
8931 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8932 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8933 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8934 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8935 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8936 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8937 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8938 backends.
8939
8940 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8941
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008942
8943option tcplog
8944 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008946 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008947 Arguments : none
8948
8949 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8950 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8951 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8952 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8953 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8954 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8955 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8956 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8957
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008958 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008960 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008961
8962
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008963option transparent
8964no option transparent
8965 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008967 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008968 Arguments : none
8969
8970 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8971 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8972 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8973 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8974 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8975 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8976 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8977 appropriate server.
8978
8979 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8980 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8981
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008982 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008983 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008984
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008985
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008986external-check command <command>
8987 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 yes | no | yes | yes
8990
8991 Arguments :
8992 <command> is the external command to run
8993
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008994 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8995
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008996 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008997
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008998 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8999 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9000 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9001 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9002 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9003 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009004
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009005 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9006
9007 Environment variables :
9008 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9009 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9010
9011 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9012
9013 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9014
9015 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9016 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9017 for a UNIX socket).
9018
9019 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9020
9021 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9022
9023 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9024
9025 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9026
9027 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9028
9029 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9030 socket).
9031
9032 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9033 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9034
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009035 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9036
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009037 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9038 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9039 failed.
9040
9041 Example :
9042 external-check command /bin/true
9043
9044 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9045
9046
9047external-check path <path>
9048 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9050 yes | no | yes | yes
9051
9052 Arguments :
9053 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9054
9055 The default path is "".
9056
9057 Example :
9058 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9059
9060 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9061 "external-check command"
9062
9063
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009064persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009065persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009066 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9068 yes | no | yes | yes
9069 Arguments :
9070 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009071 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9072 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009073
9074 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9075 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009076 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009077 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9078 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9079 forwarded to this server.
9080
9081 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9082 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9083 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009084 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009085 a single "listen" section.
9086
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009087 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9088 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9089 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9090
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009091 Example :
9092 listen tse-farm
9093 bind :3389
9094 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9095 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9096 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9097 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9098 persist rdp-cookie
9099 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009100 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009101 balance rdp-cookie
9102 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9103 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9104
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009105 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9106 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009107
9108
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009109rate-limit sessions <rate>
9110 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9112 yes | yes | yes | no
9113 Arguments :
9114 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9115 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9116
9117 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9118 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9119 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9120 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9121 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9122 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9123
9124 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9125 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9126 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9127 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9128
9129 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9130 listen smtp
9131 mode tcp
9132 bind :25
9133 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009134 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009135
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009136 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9137 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9138 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009139
9140 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9141
9142
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009143redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9144redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9145redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009146 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9148 no | yes | yes | yes
9149
9150 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009151 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009152
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009153 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009154 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009155 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9156 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9157 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009158
9159 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9160 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9161 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9162 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9163 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009164 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9165 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9166 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9167 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009168
9169 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9170 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9171 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9172 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9173 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9174 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009175 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009176 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009177 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9178 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9179 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009180
9181 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009182 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9183 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9184 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009185 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009186 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9187 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9188 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9189 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009190
9191 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009192 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009193
9194 - "drop-query"
9195 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9196 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9197 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9198 with a location-type redirect.
9199
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009200 - "append-slash"
9201 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9202 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9203 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9204 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9205
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009206 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9207 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9208 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9209 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9210 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9211 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9212 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9213
9214 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9215 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9216 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9217 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9218 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9219 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9220 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009221
9222 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9223 acl clear dst_port 80
9224 acl secure dst_port 8080
9225 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009226 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009227 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009228 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9229
9230 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009231 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9232 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9233 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009234 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009235
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009236 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9237 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9238 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9239
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009240 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009241 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009242
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009243 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009244 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9245 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9246 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009248 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009249
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009250
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009251retries <value>
9252 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9254 yes | no | yes | yes
9255 Arguments :
9256 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9257 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9258 default value is 3.
9259
9260 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9261 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9262 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9263
9264 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009265 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9266 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009267
9268 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9269 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9270
9271 See also : "option redispatch"
9272
9273
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009274retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009275 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9276 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9277 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9279 yes | no | yes | yes
9280 Arguments :
9281 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9282 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9283 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9284 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9285
9286 none never retry
9287
9288 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9289 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9290
9291 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9292 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9293 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9294 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9295 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9296 processing the request.
9297
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009298 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9299 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9300 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9301 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9302 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9303 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9304 overflow attack for example).
9305
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009306 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9307 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9308 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9309 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9310 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9311 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9312 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9313 amplify denial of service attacks.
9314
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009315 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9316 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9317 considered to be safe to retry.
9318
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009319 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9320 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9321 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9322 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9323
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009324 all-retryable-errors
9325 retry request for any error that are considered
9326 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9327 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9328 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9329
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009330 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9331 not cumulative.
9332
9333 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9334 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9335 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9336 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9337
9338 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9339 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9340 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9341 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9342 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9343 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9344 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9345 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9346 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9347 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9348 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9349 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9350
9351 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9352 should not use this directive.
9353
9354 The default is "conn-failure".
9355
9356 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9357
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009358server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009359 Declare a server in a backend
9360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9361 no | no | yes | yes
9362 Arguments :
9363 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009365 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009366
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009367 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9368 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9369 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9370 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009371 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9372 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9373 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9374 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9375 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009376 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9377 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9378 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9379 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9380 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9381 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9382 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009383 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009384 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9385 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9386 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9387 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9388 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9389 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009390 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9391 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009392 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9393 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009394
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009395 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009396 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9397 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9398 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9399 adding this value to the client's port.
9400
9401 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9402 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009403 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009404
9405 Examples :
9406 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9407 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009408 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009409 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9410 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9411 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009412
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009413 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9414 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9415 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9416 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9417 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9418
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009419 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9420 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009421
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009422server-state-file-name [<file>]
9423 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9424 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9425 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9426 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9427 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9428 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9429
9430 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9431 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9432
9433 global
9434 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9435
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009436 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009437 load-server-state-from-file
9438
9439 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9440 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009441
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009442server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9443 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9444 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9446 no | no | yes | yes
9447
9448 Arguments:
9449 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9450
9451 <num | range>
9452 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9453 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9454 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9455 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9456
9457 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9458
9459 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9460
9461 <params*>
9462 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9463 keyword.
9464
9465 Examples:
9466 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9467 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9468 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9469
9470 # or
9471 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9472
9473 # would be equivalent to:
9474 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9475 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9476 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9477
9478
9479
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009480source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009481source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009482source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009483 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9485 yes | no | yes | yes
9486 Arguments :
9487 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9488 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009489
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009490 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009491 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9492 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9493 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9494 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9495 supported prefixes are :
9496 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9497 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9498 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009499 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009500 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9501 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009502
9503 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9504 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009505 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9506 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9507 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009508
9509 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9510 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9511 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9512 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9513 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9514 <addr>.
9515
9516 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9517 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9518 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9519 port.
9520
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009521 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9522 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9523 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9524 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009525 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009526 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9527 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9528 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9529 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9530 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9531 HTTP header.
9532
9533 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9534 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009535 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009536 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9537 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9538 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9539 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9540 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9541 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9542 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9543
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009544 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9545 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9546 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9547 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9548 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9549 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9550
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009551 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9552 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9553 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9554 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9555
9556 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9557 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9558 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9559 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9560 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9561 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9562
9563 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9564 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9565 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9566 there are two methods :
9567
9568 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9569 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9570 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9571 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9572 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9573 of the client ranges may be used.
9574
9575 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9576 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9577 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9578 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9579 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9580 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9581 same session.
9582
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009583 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9584 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9585 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009586 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009587
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009588 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9589
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009590 Examples :
9591 backend private
9592 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9593 source 192.168.1.200
9594
9595 backend transparent_ssl1
9596 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9597 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9598
9599 backend transparent_ssl2
9600 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9601 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9602 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9603
9604 backend transparent_ssl3
9605 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9606 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9607 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9608
9609 backend transparent_smtp
9610 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9611 # with Tproxy version 4.
9612 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9613
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009614 backend transparent_http
9615 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9616 # proxy.
9617 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009619 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009620 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9621
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009622
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009623srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9624 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9625 the connection on the server side.
9626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9627 yes | no | yes | yes
9628 Arguments :
9629 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9630
9631 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9632 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009633 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9634 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009635
9636 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9637
9638
9639srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9640 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9641 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9642 server side.
9643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9644 yes | no | yes | yes
9645 Arguments :
9646 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9647 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9648 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9649 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9650
9651 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9652 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009653 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9654 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009655
9656 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9657
9658
9659srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9660 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9662 yes | no | yes | yes
9663 Arguments :
9664 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9665 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9666 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9667 document.
9668
9669 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9670 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009671 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9672 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009673
9674 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9675
9676
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009677stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9678 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009680 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009681
9682 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9683 matched.
9684
9685 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9686 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9687
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009688 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9689 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009690 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009691
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009692 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9693 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9694 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9695 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009696
9697 Example :
9698 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9699 backend stats_localhost
9700 stats enable
9701 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9702
9703 Example :
9704 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9705 backend stats_auth
9706 stats enable
9707 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9708 stats admin if TRUE
9709
9710 Example :
9711 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9712 userlist stats-auth
9713 group admin users admin
9714 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9715 group readonly users haproxy
9716 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9717
9718 backend stats_auth
9719 stats enable
9720 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9721 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9722 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9723 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9724
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009725 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9726 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9727 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009728
9729
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009730stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9731 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009733 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009734 Arguments :
9735 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9736
9737 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9738
9739 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9740 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9741 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9742 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9743 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9744 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9745
9746 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9747 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9748 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009749 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009750
9751 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9752 report using "stats scope".
9753
9754 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9755 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9756 unobvious parameters.
9757
9758 Example :
9759 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9760 backend public_www
9761 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9762 stats enable
9763 stats hide-version
9764 stats scope .
9765 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009767 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9768 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9769
9770 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9771 backend private_monitoring
9772 stats enable
9773 stats uri /admin?stats
9774 stats refresh 5s
9775
9776 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9777
9778
9779stats enable
9780 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009782 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009783 Arguments : none
9784
9785 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9786 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9787 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9788 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9789 - stats auth : no authentication
9790 - stats scope : no restriction
9791
9792 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9793 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9794 unobvious parameters.
9795
9796 Example :
9797 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9798 backend public_www
9799 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9800 stats enable
9801 stats hide-version
9802 stats scope .
9803 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009804 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009805 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9806 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9807
9808 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9809 backend private_monitoring
9810 stats enable
9811 stats uri /admin?stats
9812 stats refresh 5s
9813
9814 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9815
9816
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009817stats hide-version
9818 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009820 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009821 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009822
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009823 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9824 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9825 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9826 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9827 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9828 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009830 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9831 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9832 unobvious parameters.
9833
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009834 Example :
9835 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9836 backend public_www
9837 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009838 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009839 stats hide-version
9840 stats scope .
9841 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009842 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009843 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9844 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009845
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009846 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9847 backend private_monitoring
9848 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009849 stats uri /admin?stats
9850 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009851
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009852 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009853
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009854
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009855stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9856 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9857 Access control for statistics
9858
9859 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9860 no | no | yes | yes
9861
9862 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9863 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9864 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9865 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9866 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9867 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9868
9869 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9870 instance.
9871
9872 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9873 about ACL usage.
9874
9875
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009876stats realm <realm>
9877 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009879 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009880 Arguments :
9881 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9882 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9883 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9884
9885 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9886 using a backslash ('\').
9887
9888 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9889 only related to authentication.
9890
9891 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9892 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9893 unobvious parameters.
9894
9895 Example :
9896 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9897 backend public_www
9898 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9899 stats enable
9900 stats hide-version
9901 stats scope .
9902 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009903 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009904 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9905 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9906
9907 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9908 backend private_monitoring
9909 stats enable
9910 stats uri /admin?stats
9911 stats refresh 5s
9912
9913 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9914
9915
9916stats refresh <delay>
9917 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009919 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009920 Arguments :
9921 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9922 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9923 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9924 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9925 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9926 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9927
9928 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9929 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9930 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009931 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009932
9933 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9934 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9935 unobvious parameters.
9936
9937 Example :
9938 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9939 backend public_www
9940 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9941 stats enable
9942 stats hide-version
9943 stats scope .
9944 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009945 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009946 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9947 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9948
9949 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9950 backend private_monitoring
9951 stats enable
9952 stats uri /admin?stats
9953 stats refresh 5s
9954
9955 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9956
9957
9958stats scope { <name> | "." }
9959 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009961 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009962 Arguments :
9963 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9964 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9965 section in which the statement appears.
9966
9967 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9968 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9969 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9970 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9971 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9972 exists.
9973
9974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9976 unobvious parameters.
9977
9978 Example :
9979 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9980 backend public_www
9981 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9982 stats enable
9983 stats hide-version
9984 stats scope .
9985 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009986 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009987 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9988 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9989
9990 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9991 backend private_monitoring
9992 stats enable
9993 stats uri /admin?stats
9994 stats refresh 5s
9995
9996 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009998
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009999stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010000 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010003
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010004 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010005 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10006
10007 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10008 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10009
10010 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10011 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010012 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010013
10014 Example :
10015 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10016 backend private_monitoring
10017 stats enable
10018 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10019 stats uri /admin?stats
10020 stats refresh 5s
10021
10022 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10023 global section.
10024
10025
10026stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010027 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10029 yes | yes | yes | yes
10030 Arguments : none
10031
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010032 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010033 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10034 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10035 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10036 - IP (socket, server)
10037 - cookie (backend, server)
10038
10039 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10040 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010041 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010042
10043 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10044
10045
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010046stats show-modules
10047 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10049 yes | yes | yes | yes
10050 Arguments : none
10051
10052 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10053 values as a tooltip.
10054
10055 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10056 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10057 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10058
10059 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10060
10061
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010062stats show-node [ <name> ]
10063 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010065 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010066 Arguments:
10067 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10068 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10069
10070 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10071 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010072 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010073
10074 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10075 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10076 unobvious parameters.
10077
10078 Example:
10079 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10080 backend private_monitoring
10081 stats enable
10082 stats show-node Europe-1
10083 stats uri /admin?stats
10084 stats refresh 5s
10085
10086 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10087 section.
10088
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010089
10090stats uri <prefix>
10091 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010093 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010094 Arguments :
10095 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10096 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10097 query string.
10098
10099 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10100 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10101 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10102 possible to reach it in the application.
10103
10104 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010105 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010106 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10107 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10108 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10109 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10110
10111 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10112 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10113 an address or a port to statistics only.
10114
10115 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10116 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10117 unobvious parameters.
10118
10119 Example :
10120 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10121 backend public_www
10122 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10123 stats enable
10124 stats hide-version
10125 stats scope .
10126 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010127 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010128 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10129 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10130
10131 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10132 backend private_monitoring
10133 stats enable
10134 stats uri /admin?stats
10135 stats refresh 5s
10136
10137 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10138
10139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010140stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10141 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010143 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010144
10145 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010146 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010147 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010148 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010149 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10150
10151 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10152 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10153 the "stick-table" statement.
10154
10155 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10156 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10157 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10158 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10159 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10160
10161 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10162 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10163 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10164 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10165 transformation rules.
10166
10167 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10168 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10169 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10170 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10171 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10172 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10173 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10174
10175 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10176 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10177 ACL based conditions.
10178
10179 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10180 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10181 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10182 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10183
10184 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10185 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10186 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10187 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10188
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010189 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10190 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010191 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010192
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010193 Example :
10194 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10195 # last 30 minutes
10196 backend pop
10197 mode tcp
10198 balance roundrobin
10199 stick store-request src
10200 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10201 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10202 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10203
10204 backend smtp
10205 mode tcp
10206 balance roundrobin
10207 stick match src table pop
10208 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10209 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10210
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010211 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010212 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010213
10214
10215stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10216 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10218 no | no | yes | yes
10219
10220 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10221 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10222 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10223 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10224
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010225 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10226 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010227 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010228
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010229 Examples :
10230 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010231 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010232
10233 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10234 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10235 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10236
10237
10238 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10239 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10240 backend http
10241 mode http
10242 balance roundrobin
10243 stick on src table https
10244 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10245 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10246 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10247
10248 backend https
10249 mode tcp
10250 balance roundrobin
10251 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10252 stick on src
10253 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10254 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10255
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010256 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010257
10258
10259stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10260 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10262 no | no | yes | yes
10263
10264 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010265 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010266 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010267 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010268 server is selected.
10269
10270 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10271 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10272 the "stick-table" statement.
10273
10274 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10275 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10276 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10277 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10278 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10279 address.
10280
10281 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10282 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10283 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10284 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10285 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10286 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10287 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10288 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10289 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10290 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10291
10292 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10293 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10294 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10295 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10296 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10297 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10298 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10299
10300 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10301 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10302 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10303 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10304
10305 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10306 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10307 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10308 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10309 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10310 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010311 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10312 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10313 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10314 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10315 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10316 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010317
10318 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10319 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10320 the request.
10321
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010322 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10323 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010324 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010325
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010326 Example :
10327 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10328 # last 30 minutes
10329 backend pop
10330 mode tcp
10331 balance roundrobin
10332 stick store-request src
10333 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10334 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10335 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10336
10337 backend smtp
10338 mode tcp
10339 balance roundrobin
10340 stick match src table pop
10341 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10342 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10343
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010344 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010345 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010346
10347
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010348stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010349 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10350 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010351 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010353 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010354
10355 Arguments :
10356 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10357 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10358 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10359 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10360
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010361 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10362 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10363 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10364 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10365
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010366 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10367 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10368 instance.
10369
10370 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10371 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10372 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10373 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10374 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10375 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010376 to 32 characters.
10377
10378 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10379 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10380 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010381 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010382 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10383 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010384
10385 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010386 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10387 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010388 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10389 increase.
10390
10391 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010392 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10393 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10394 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010395
10396 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10397 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10398 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10399 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010400 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010401 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10402 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10403 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10404 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10405 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10406 parameter (see below).
10407
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010408 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10409 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10410 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10411 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10412 soft restart.
10413
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010414 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10415 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010416
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010417 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10418 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10419 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10420 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010421 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010422 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010423 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10424 if not expiration delay is specified.
10425
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010426 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10427 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10428 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10429 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010430 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10431 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10432 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10433 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10434 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10435 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10436 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10437 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10438 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10439 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10440 types and their arguments.
10441
10442 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10443 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10444 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10445 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10446
10447 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10448 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10449 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010450 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010451
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010452 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10453 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10454 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010455 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010456 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010457 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010458
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010459 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10460 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10461 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10462 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10463
10464 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10465 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10466 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10467 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10468 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10469 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10470
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010471 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10472 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10473 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10474 they were received.
10475
10476 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10477 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10478 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10479 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10480 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10481
10482 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10483 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10484 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10485 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10486 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10487
10488 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10489 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10490 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10491
10492 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10493 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10494 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10495 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10496 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10497
10498 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10499 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10500 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10501 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10502 the client side.
10503
10504 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10505 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10506 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10507 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10508 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10509 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10510 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10511
10512 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10513 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10514 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10515 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10516 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10517 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010518 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010519
10520 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10521 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10522 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10523 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10524 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10525 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10526
10527 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010528 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010529 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10530 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10531
10532 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10533 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10534 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10535 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10536 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10537 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10538 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10539 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10540 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10541 recommended for better fairness.
10542
10543 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010544 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010545 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10546 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10547
10548 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10549 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10550 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10551 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10552 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10553 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10554 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10555 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10556 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10557 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010558
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010559 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10560 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010561 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10562 reference it.
10563
10564 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10565 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010566 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10567 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10568 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010569
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010570 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10571 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10572 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10573 something that can be ignored.
10574
10575 Example:
10576 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10577 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10578 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10579 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10580
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010581 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010582 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010583
10584
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010585stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010586 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10588 no | no | yes | yes
10589
10590 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010591 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010592 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010594 server is selected.
10595
10596 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10597 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10598 the "stick-table" statement.
10599
10600 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10601 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10602 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10603 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10604
10605 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10606 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10607 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10608 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10609 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10610 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010611 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010612 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10613 rules.
10614
10615 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10616 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10617 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10618 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10619 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10620 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10621 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10622
10623 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10624 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10625 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10626 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10627
10628 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10629 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10630 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10631 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10632 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10633 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010634 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10635 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10636 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10637 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10638 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10639 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10640 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10641 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10642 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010643
10644 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10645
10646 Example :
10647 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10648 backend https
10649 mode tcp
10650 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010651 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010652 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010653
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010654 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10655 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10656
10657 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10658 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10659 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10660
10661 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10662 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010663
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010664 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10665 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10666 # at offset 44.
10667
10668 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10669 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10670
10671 # Learn on response if server hello.
10672 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010673
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010674 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10675 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10676
10677 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10678 extraction.
10679
10680
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010681tcp-check comment <string>
10682 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10683 it fails.
10684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10685 yes | no | yes | yes
10686
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010687 Arguments :
10688 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10689 rule fails.
10690
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010691 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10692 user-friendly error reporting.
10693
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010694 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10695 "tcp-check expect".
10696
10697
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010698tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10699 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010700 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010701 Opens a new connection
10702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010703 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010704
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010705 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010706 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10707
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010708 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010709 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010710
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010711 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010712 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10713 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010714 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010715
10716 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010717
10718 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10719
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010720 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10721
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010722 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10723
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010724 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10725
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010726 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10727 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10728 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10729 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10730
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010731 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10732 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10733 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10734 haproxy -vv.
10735
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010736 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010737
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010738 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10739 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10740 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10741
10742 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10743 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10744 of the sequence.
10745
10746 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10747 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10748 do.
10749
10750 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10751 unset-var or comment rules.
10752
10753 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010754 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10755 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10756 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10757 option tcp-check
10758 tcp-check connect
10759 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10760 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10761 tcp-check send \r\n
10762 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10763 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10764 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10765 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10766 tcp-check send \r\n
10767 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10768 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10769
10770 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10771 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010772 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010773 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10774 tcp-check connect port 143
10775 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10776 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10777
10778 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10779
10780
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010781tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010782 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010783 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010784 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010787 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010788
10789 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010790 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10791
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010792 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10793 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10794 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10795 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10796 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10797 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10798 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10799 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10800 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10801 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10802
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010803 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010804 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10805 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010806 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10807 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10808 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10809
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010810 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10811 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10812 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010813 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10814 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10815 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10816 example 404 with disable-on-404
10817 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10818 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010819 By default "L7OK" is used.
10820
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010821 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10822 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010823 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10824 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10825 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10826 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10827 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10828 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010829
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010830 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010831 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010832 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10833 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10834 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10835 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010836 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10837
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010838 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10839 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10840 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10841 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10842
10843 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10844 informational message reported in logs if an error
10845 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10846 log-format string.
10847
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010848 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10849 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10850 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10851 followed by some converters.
10852
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010853 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10854 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10855 with the usual backslash ('\').
10856 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010857 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010858 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10859 used upper or lower case.
10860
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010861 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10862
10863 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10864 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10865 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10866 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10867 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10868 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10869 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10870 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10871
10872 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10873 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10874 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10875 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10876 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10877 expression.
10878
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010879 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10880 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10881 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10882 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10883 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10884 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10885
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010886 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10887 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10888 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10889 this exact hexadecimal string.
10890 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10891
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010892 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10893 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10894 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10895 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10896 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10897 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10898 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10899 size.
10900
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010901 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10902 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10903 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10904 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10905 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10906 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10907 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10908 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10909 in a binary string before matching the response's
10910 buffer.
10911
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010912 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10913 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10914 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10915 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10916 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10917 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10918 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10919 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10920 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10921 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10922 the null character.
10923
10924 Examples :
10925 # perform a POP check
10926 option tcp-check
10927 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10928
10929 # perform an IMAP check
10930 option tcp-check
10931 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10932
10933 # look for the redis master server
10934 option tcp-check
10935 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010936 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010937 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10938 tcp-check expect string role:master
10939 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10940 tcp-check expect string +OK
10941
10942
10943 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10944 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10945
10946
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010947tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10948tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10949 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10950 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010953
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010954 Arguments :
10955 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10956
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010957 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10958 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010959
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010960 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10961 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010962
10963 Examples :
10964 # look for the redis master server
10965 option tcp-check
10966 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10967 tcp-check expect string role:master
10968
10969 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10970 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10971
10972
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010973tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10974tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10975 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10976 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010978 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010979
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010980 Arguments :
10981 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010982
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010983 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10984 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010985
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010986 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10987 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10988 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010989
10990 Examples :
10991 # redis check in binary
10992 option tcp-check
10993 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10994 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10995
10996
10997 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10998 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10999
11000
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011001tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011002 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011004 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011005
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011006 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011007 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11008 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11009 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11010 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11011 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11012 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11013 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11014 and '-'.
11015
11016 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11017
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011018 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011019 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11020
11021
11022tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011023 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011025 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011026
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011027 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011028 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11029 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11030 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11031 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11032 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11033 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11034 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11035 and '-'.
11036
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011037 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011038 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11039
11040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011041tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11042 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11044 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011045 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011046 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11047 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011049 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011050
11051 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11052 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011053 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11054 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11055 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11056 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11057 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11058 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011060 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11061 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11062 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11063 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011064
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011065 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011066 - accept :
11067 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11068 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11069 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011071 - reject :
11072 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11073 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11074 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11075 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11076 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11077 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11078 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11079 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11080 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11081 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11082 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011083 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011084
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011085 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11086 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11087 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11088 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11089 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11090 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11091 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11092 hosts.
11093
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011094 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11095 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11096 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11097 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11098 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11099 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11100 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11101 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11102
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011103 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11104 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11105 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11106 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11107 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11108 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11109 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11110 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11111 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011112 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11113 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011114
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011115 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011116 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011117 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11118 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11119 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011120 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011121 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
11122 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11123 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11124 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11125 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11126 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11127 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11128 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011130 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011131 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011133 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011134 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11135 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11136 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011138 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11139 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11140 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11141 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011143 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11144 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11145 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11146 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11147 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011148 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11149 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11150 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11151 layer7 information is extracted.
11152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011153 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11154 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11155 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11156 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11157 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011158
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011159 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11160 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11161 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11162 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11163
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011164 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11165 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11166 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11167 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11168
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011169 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11170 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11171 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11172 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11173 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011174
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011175 - set-src <expr> :
11176 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11177 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11178 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011179 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011181 Arguments:
11182 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11183 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011184
11185 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011186 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11187
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011188 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11189 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011190
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011191 - set-src-port <expr> :
11192 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11193 expression.
11194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011195 Arguments:
11196 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11197 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011198
11199 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011200 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11201
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011202 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11203 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11204 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011205
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011206 - set-dst <expr> :
11207 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11208 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11209 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11210 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11211 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11212
11213 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11214 followed by some converters.
11215
11216 Example:
11217
11218 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11219 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11220
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011221 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11222 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11223
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011224 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11225 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11226 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11227 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11228
11229
11230 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11231 followed by some converters.
11232
11233 Example:
11234
11235 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11236
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011237 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11238 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11239 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11240
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011241 - "silent-drop" :
11242 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011243 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011244 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11245 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11246 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11247 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11248 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011249 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11250 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011251 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11252 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011253 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011254 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11255 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11256 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11257 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011259 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11260 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11261 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011263 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11264 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11265 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011267 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011268 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011269 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011271 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11272 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11273 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011275 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011276 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11277 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011278
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011279 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11280
11281 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11282
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011283 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11284
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011285 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011286
11287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011288tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11289 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011291 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011292 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011293 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11294 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011296 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011297
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011298 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011299 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11300 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11301 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11302 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011304 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11305 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11306 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11307 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011308 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11309 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11310 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11311 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11312 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11313 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011314 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011315 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011317 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11318 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11319 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11320 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011321
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011322 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011323 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011324 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011325 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11326 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011327 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011328 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011329 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011330 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011331 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011332 - set-dst <expr>
11333 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011334 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011335 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011336 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011337 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011338 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011339
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011340 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11341 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011342 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11343 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011344
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011345 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11346 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11347 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11348 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11349 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11350 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011352 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011353 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11354 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011355
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011356 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11357 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11358 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11359 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11360 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11361 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11362
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011363 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011364 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11365 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11366 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11367 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11368 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11369 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11370 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11371 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11372 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11373 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011374
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011375 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011376 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11377 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11378 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011379
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011380 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11381 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11382
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011383 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011384 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11385 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011386
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011387 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11388 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011389 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011390 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11391 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011392 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011393 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011394 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011395 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11396 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011397 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011398 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11399 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011400
11401 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11402 followed by some converters.
11403
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011404 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11405 <var-name>.
11406
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011407 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11408 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11409 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11410 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11411 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11412
11413 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11414 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11415 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11416 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11417 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11418 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11419 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11420 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11421 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11422 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11423 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11424
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011425 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11426 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11427 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11428 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11429 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11430
11431 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11432
11433 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11434
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011435 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11436 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11437 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11438 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11439 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11440 evaluated.
11441
11442 Example:
11443 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11444
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011445 Example:
11446
11447 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011448 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011449
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011450 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011451 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11452 # and reject everything else.
11453 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11454 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011455 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011456 tcp-request content reject
11457
11458 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011459 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11460 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11461 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011462 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011463
11464 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11465 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11466 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011467 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011468 tcp-request content reject
11469
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011470 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011471 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011472 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011473 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011474 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11475 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011476
11477 Example:
11478 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11479 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011480 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011481
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011482 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011483 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011484
11485 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011486 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011487 # protecting all our sites
11488 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011489 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11490 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011491 ...
11492 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11493
11494 backend http_dynamic
11495 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011496 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011497 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011498 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011499 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011500 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011501 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011503 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011504
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011505 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11506 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011507
11508
11509tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11510 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011512 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011513 Arguments :
11514 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11516 as explained at the top of this document.
11517
11518 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11519 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11520 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11521 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11522 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11523
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011524 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11525 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11526 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11527 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11528
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011529 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11530 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011531 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011532 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011533 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11534 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11535 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11536 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011537
11538 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11539 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11540 it pass through unaffected.
11541
11542 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11543 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11544 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011545 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011546 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11547 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011548 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11549 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11550 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011551
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011552 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011553 "timeout client".
11554
11555
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011556tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11557 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11559 no | no | yes | yes
11560 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011561 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11562 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011563
11564 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11565
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011566 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011567 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11568 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011569 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11570 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011571
11572 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11573
11574 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11575 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11576 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11577 inserted.
11578
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011579 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011580 - accept :
11581 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11582 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11583 the rules evaluation.
11584
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011585 - close :
11586 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11587 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11588 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11589 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11590 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11591 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011592 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011593 protocols.
11594
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011595 - reject :
11596 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11597 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011598 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011599
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011600 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11601 Sets a variable.
11602
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011603 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11604 Unsets a variable.
11605
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011606 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11607 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11608 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11609 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011611 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11612 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11613 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11614 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11615
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011616 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11617 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11618 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11619 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11620 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011621
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011622 - "silent-drop" :
11623 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011624 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011625 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11626 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11627 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11628 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11629 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011630 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11631 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011632 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11633 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011634 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011635 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11636 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11637 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11638 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11639
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011640 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11641 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11642
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011643 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11644 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11645 for changing the default action to a reject.
11646
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011647 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11648 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11649 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11650 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011651 period.
11652
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011653 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11654 declared inline.
11655
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011656 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11657 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011658 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011659 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11660 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011661 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011662 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011663 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011664 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11665 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011666 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011667 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11668 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011669
11670 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11671 followed by some converters.
11672
11673 Example:
11674
11675 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11676
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011677 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11678 <var-name>.
11679
11680 Example:
11681
11682 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11683
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011684 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11685 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11686 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11687 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11688 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11689
11690 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11691
11692 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11693
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011694 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11695
11696 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11697
11698
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011699tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11700 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11702 no | yes | yes | no
11703 Arguments :
11704 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11705 below.
11706
11707 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11708
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011709 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011710 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11711 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11712 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11713 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11714 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11715 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11716 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011717 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011718 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11719 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11720 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11721 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11722 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11723 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11724 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11725 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11726 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11727 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11728 instead.
11729
11730 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11731 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11732 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11733 rules which may be inserted.
11734
11735 Several types of actions are supported :
11736 - accept : the request is accepted
11737 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11738 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11739 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011740 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011741 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011742 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011743 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011744 - silent-drop
11745
11746 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11747 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11748 sections for a complete description.
11749
11750 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11751 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11752 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11753
11754 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11755 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11756 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11757 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11758 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11759
11760 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11761 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11762
11763 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11764 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11765 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11766
11767 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11768 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11769 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11770
11771 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11772 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11773 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11774
11775 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11776 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11777 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11778
11779 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11780
11781 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11782
11783
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011784tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11785 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11787 no | no | yes | yes
11788 Arguments :
11789 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11790 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11791 as explained at the top of this document.
11792
11793 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11794
11795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011796timeout check <timeout>
11797 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11798 established.
11799
11800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11801 yes | no | yes | yes
11802 Arguments:
11803 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11804 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11805 as explained at the top of this document.
11806
11807 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11808 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011809 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011810 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011811 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11812 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11813 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011814
11815 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11816 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11817
11818 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11819 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011820 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011821
11822 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11823 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11824 forget about it.
11825
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011826 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11827 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011828
11829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011830timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011831 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11833 yes | yes | yes | no
11834 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011835 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11837 as explained at the top of this document.
11838
11839 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11840 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11841 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011842 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11843 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11844 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11845 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011846 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11847 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11848 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011849 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011850 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011851 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11852 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011853 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11854 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011855
11856 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11857 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11858 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11859 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011860 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011861 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11862
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011863 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011864
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011865 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011867
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011868timeout client-fin <timeout>
11869 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11871 yes | yes | yes | no
11872 Arguments :
11873 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11874 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11875 as explained at the top of this document.
11876
11877 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11878 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11879 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11880 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11881 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11882 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11883 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011884 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11885 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11886 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011887
11888 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11889 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11890 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11891
11892 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11893
11894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011895timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011896 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11898 yes | no | yes | yes
11899 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011900 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11902 as explained at the top of this document.
11903
11904 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011905 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011906 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011907 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011908 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11909 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011910
11911 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11912 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11913 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11914 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011915 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011916 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11917
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011918 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011919
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011920
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011921timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11922 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11924 yes | yes | yes | yes
11925 Arguments :
11926 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11927 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11928 as explained at the top of this document.
11929
11930 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11931 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11932 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11933 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11934 once the request has started to present itself.
11935
11936 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11937 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11938 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11939 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11940 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11941
11942 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11943 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11944 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11945 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11946
11947 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11948 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011949 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011950 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11951 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011952 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011953
11954 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11955 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11956 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11957 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11958
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011959 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11960 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011961 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11962
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011963 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11964
11965
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011966timeout http-request <timeout>
11967 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011969 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011970 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011971 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011972 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11973 as explained at the top of this document.
11974
11975 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11976 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11977 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11978 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11979 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11980 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11981 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011982 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11983 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11984 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11985 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011986 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011987 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11988 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011989
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011990 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11991 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11992 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11993 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11994 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011995 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011996
11997 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11998 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011999 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012000 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12001 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12002
12003 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012004 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12005 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12006 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012007
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012008 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012009 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012010
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012011
12012timeout queue <timeout>
12013 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12015 yes | no | yes | yes
12016 Arguments :
12017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12019 as explained at the top of this document.
12020
12021 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12022 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12023 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12024 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12025 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12026
12027 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12028 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12029 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12030 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12031
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012032 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012033
12034
12035timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012036 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12038 yes | no | yes | yes
12039 Arguments :
12040 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12041 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12042 as explained at the top of this document.
12043
12044 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12045 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12046 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12047 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12048 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12049 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12050 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12051
12052 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12053 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12054 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12055 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12056 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012057 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012058 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12060 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012061 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12062 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012063
12064 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12065 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12066 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12067 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012068 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012069 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12070
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012071 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012072
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012073
12074timeout server-fin <timeout>
12075 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12077 yes | no | yes | yes
12078 Arguments :
12079 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12080 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12081 as explained at the top of this document.
12082
12083 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12084 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12085 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12086 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12087 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12088 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12089 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12090 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12091 situations, it should not be needed.
12092
12093 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12094 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12095 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12096
12097 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12098
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012099
12100timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012101 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12103 yes | yes | yes | yes
12104 Arguments :
12105 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12106 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12107 as explained at the top of this document.
12108
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012109 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12110 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12111 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012112
12113 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12114 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12115 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12116 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012117 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012118
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012119 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012120
12121
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012122timeout tunnel <timeout>
12123 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12125 yes | no | yes | yes
12126 Arguments :
12127 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12128 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12129 as explained at the top of this document.
12130
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012131 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012132 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12133 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12134 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012135 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12136 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012137 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12138 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12139 specified.
12140
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012141 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12142 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12143 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12144 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12145 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12146 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12147 state.
12148
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012149 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12150 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12151 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12152 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012153 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012154
12155 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12156 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12157 forget about it.
12158
12159 Example :
12160 defaults http
12161 option http-server-close
12162 timeout connect 5s
12163 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012164 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012165 timeout server 30s
12166 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12167
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012168 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012169
12170
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012171transparent (deprecated)
12172 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012174 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012175 Arguments : none
12176
12177 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12178 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12179 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12180 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12181 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12182 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12183 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12184 appropriate server.
12185
12186 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12187
12188 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12189 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12190
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012191 See also: "option transparent"
12192
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012193unique-id-format <string>
12194 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12196 yes | yes | yes | no
12197 Arguments :
12198 <string> is a log-format string.
12199
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012200 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12201 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12202 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12203 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012204
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012205 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12206 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12207 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12208 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12209 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12210 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12211 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12212 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012213
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012214 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12215 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012216
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012217 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012218
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012219 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012220
12221 will generate:
12222
12223 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12224
12225 See also: "unique-id-header"
12226
12227unique-id-header <name>
12228 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12230 yes | yes | yes | no
12231 Arguments :
12232 <name> is the name of the header.
12233
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012234 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12235 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012236
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012237 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012238
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012239 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012240 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12241
12242 will generate:
12243
12244 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12245
12246 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012247
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012248use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012249 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12251 no | yes | yes | no
12252 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012253 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12254 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012255
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012256 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12257 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012258
12259 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12260 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12261 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012262 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012263 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012264 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12265 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012266
12267 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12268 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12269 assign the backend.
12270
12271 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12272 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12273 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12274 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12275 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12276 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12277
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012278 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012279 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012280 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12281 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12282 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12283
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012284 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12285 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12286 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12287 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12288 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12289 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12290 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12291 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12292 cannot be forced from the request.
12293
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012294 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012295 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12296 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12297
12298 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12299 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012300
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012301use-fcgi-app <name>
12302 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12304 no | no | yes | yes
12305 Arguments :
12306 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12307
12308 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012309
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012310use-server <server> if <condition>
12311use-server <server> unless <condition>
12312 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12314 no | no | yes | yes
12315 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012316 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12317 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012318
12319 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12320
12321 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12322 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12323 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12324
12325 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12326 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12327 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12328 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12329 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12330 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12331 matches will assign the server.
12332
12333 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12334 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12335 with the next rules until one matches.
12336
12337 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12338 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12339 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12340 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12341
12342 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12343 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12344 stripped.
12345
12346 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12347 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012348 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12349 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12350 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012351
12352 Example :
12353 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12354 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12355 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12356 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012357 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012358 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012359 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012360 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12361 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12362
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012363 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12364 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12365 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12366 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012367 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012368 and we fall back to load balancing.
12369
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012370 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012371
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012372
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123735. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012374--------------------------
12375
12376The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12377depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12378settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12379written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12380described in this section.
12381
12382
123835.1. Bind options
12384-----------------
12385
12386The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12387as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12388no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12389parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12390while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12391provided immediately after the setting name.
12392
12393The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12394
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012395accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12396 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12397 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12398 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12399 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12400 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12401 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12402 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12403 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12404 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012405 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12406 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12407 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012409accept-proxy
12410 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012411 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12412 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012413 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12414 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12415 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12416 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012417 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012418 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12419 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012420 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12421 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012422
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012423allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012424 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012425 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012426 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012427 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12428 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012429
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012430alpn <protocols>
12431 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12432 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12433 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012434 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012435 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012436 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12437 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12438 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12439 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12440 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12441 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12442 preference, like below :
12443
12444 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012445
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012446backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012447 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012448 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12449
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012450curves <curves>
12451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12452 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12453 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12454 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12455 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12456 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12457
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012458ecdhe <named curve>
12459 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012460 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12461 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012462
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012463ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12465 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12466 client's certificate.
12467
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012468ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12470 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12471 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12472 error is ignored.
12473
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012474ca-sign-file <cafile>
12475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12476 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12477 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12478 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12479 'generate-certificates' for details.
12480
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012481ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12483 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12484 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12485 'generate-certificates' for details.
12486
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012487ca-verify-file <cafile>
12488 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12489 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12490 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12491 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12492 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12493
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012494ciphers <ciphers>
12495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12496 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012497 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012498 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012499 information and recommendations see e.g.
12500 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12501 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12502 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12503
12504ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12506 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12507 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12508 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012509 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12510 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012511
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012512crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12514 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12515 to verify client's certificate.
12516
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012517crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12519 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12520 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12521 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12522 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012523 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12524 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012525
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012526 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12527 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12528
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012529 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12530 are loaded.
12531
12532 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012533 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12534 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12535 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12536 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12537 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12538 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12539 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012540 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012541
12542 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12543 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12544 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12545 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012546 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12547 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012548
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012549 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012550
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012551 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012552 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012553 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12554 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012555 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12556 clients).
12557
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012558 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12559 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12560 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12561 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12562 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12563 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12564 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12565 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12566 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12567 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12568 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12569 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12570 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12571
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012572 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12573 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12574 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12575 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12576 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12577
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012578 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12579 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12580 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12581 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012582
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012583 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12584 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12585 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012586
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012587crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012589 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012590 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012591 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012592
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012593crt-list <file>
12594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012595 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12596 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012597
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012598 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12599
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012600 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12601 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12602 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12603 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12604 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012605
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012606 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12607 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12608 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12609 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12610 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12611 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12612 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12613 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012614
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012615 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12616 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12617 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012618
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012619 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12620
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012621 crt-list file example:
12622 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012623 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012624 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012625 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012626 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012627
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012628defer-accept
12629 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12630 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12631 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012632 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012633 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12634 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12635 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12636 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12637 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12638 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12639 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12640
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012641expose-fd listeners
12642 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12643 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012644 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12645 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012646 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012647
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012648force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012649 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012650 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012651 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012652 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012653
12654force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012655 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012656 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012657 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012658
12659force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012660 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012661 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012662 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012663
12664force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012665 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012666 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012667 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012668
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012669force-tlsv13
12670 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12671 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012672 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012673
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012674generate-certificates
12675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12676 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12677 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12678 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12679 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12680 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12681 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12682 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12683 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12684 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12685 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12686
12687 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12688 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012689 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012690 certificate is used many times.
12691
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012692gid <gid>
12693 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12694 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12695 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12696 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12697 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12698
12699group <group>
12700 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12701 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12702 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12703 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12704 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12705
12706id <id>
12707 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12708 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12709 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12710 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12711
12712interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012713 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12714 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12715 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12716 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12717 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12718 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012719 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12720 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12721 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12722 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12723 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12724 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012725
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012726level <level>
12727 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12728 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12729 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012730 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012731 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12732 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12733 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012734 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012735 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012737 all counters).
12738
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012739severity-output <format>
12740 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12741 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12742 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12743 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12744 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12745 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12746 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12747 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12748 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12749 rfc5424 convention.
12750
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012751maxconn <maxconn>
12752 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12753 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12754 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12755 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12756 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12757 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12758 eat all memory.
12759
12760mode <mode>
12761 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12762 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12763 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12764 UNIX sockets.
12765
12766mss <maxseg>
12767 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12768 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12769 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12770 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12771 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12772 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12773 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12774 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12775 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12776 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12777 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12778
12779name <name>
12780 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12781 page.
12782
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012783namespace <name>
12784 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12785 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12786 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12787 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12788
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012789nice <nice>
12790 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12791 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12792 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12793 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12794 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12795 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12796 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12797 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12798 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12799 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12800 one for an RDP socket.
12801
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012802no-ca-names
12803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12804 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012805 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012806
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012807no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012809 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012810 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012811 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012812 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12813 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012814
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012815no-tls-tickets
12816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12817 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12818 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012819 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12820 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012821 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12822 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12823 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012824
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012825no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012827 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012828 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012829 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012830 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12831 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012832
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012833no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012835 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012836 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012837 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012838 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12839 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012840
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012841no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012843 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012844 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012845 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012846 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12847 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012848
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012849no-tlsv13
12850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12851 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12852 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12853 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012854 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12855 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012856
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012857npn <protocols>
12858 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12859 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12860 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012861 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012862 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012863 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12864 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12865 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12866 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12867 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012868
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012869prefer-client-ciphers
12870 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12871 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12872 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012873 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12874 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12875 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012876
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012877process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012878 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012879 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012880 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012881 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12882 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12883 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12884 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012885 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012886 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12887 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12888 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12889 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12890 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012891
12892 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12893
12894 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12895 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12896 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12897 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12898 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12899 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12900 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12901 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012902
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012903proto <name>
12904 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12905 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12906 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12907 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012908 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012909 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012910 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012911 h2" on the bind line.
12912
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012913ssl
12914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012915 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012916 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12917 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012918 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12919 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012920
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012921ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12922 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012923 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12924 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12925 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012926 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12927
12928ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012929 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12930 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12931 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12932 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012933
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012934strict-sni
12935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12936 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12937 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12938 See the "crt" option for more information.
12939
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012940tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012941 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012942 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12943 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012944 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012945 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12946 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12947 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12948 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12949 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12950 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12951 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12952
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012953tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012954 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012955 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12956 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12957 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12958 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12959 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12960 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12961 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012962 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12963 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12964 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012965
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012966tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12967 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012968 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12969 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12970 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12971 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12972 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12973 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12974 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12975 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12976 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12977 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012978 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12979 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12980
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012981transparent
12982 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12983 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12984 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12985 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12986 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12987 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12988 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12989 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12990 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12991 so check for support with your vendor.
12992
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012993v4v6
12994 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12995 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12996 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12997 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012998 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012999
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013000v6only
13001 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13002 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13003 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013004 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13005 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013006
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013007uid <uid>
13008 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13009 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13010 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13011 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13012 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13013
13014user <user>
13015 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13016 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13017 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13018 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13019 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13020
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013021verify [none|optional|required]
13022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13023 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13024 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13025 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13026 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013027 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13028 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13029 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13030 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013031
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200130325.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013033------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013035The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13036which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13037arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13038settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13039after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13040Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13041address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013043 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013044 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013045
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013046Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13047keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013049The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013050
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013051addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013052 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013053 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13054 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13055 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13056 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13057 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013058
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013059agent-check
13060 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013061 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013062 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13063 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13064 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013065
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013066 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013067 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013068 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13069 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13070 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013071
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013072 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13073 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13074 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13075 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13076 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013077
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013078 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013079 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013080
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013081 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13082 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13083 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013084
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013085 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13086 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13087 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013088
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013089 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013090 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13091 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13092 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13093 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013094 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013095 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013096
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013097 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13098 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013099
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013100 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13101 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13102 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13103 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13104 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13105 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13106 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13107 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13108 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013109
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013110 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13111 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013112 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13113 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13114 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013115 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013116
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013117 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013118 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013119
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013120agent-send <string>
13121 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13122 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13123 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13124 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13125 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13126
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013127agent-inter <delay>
13128 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13129 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13130
13131 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13132 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13133 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13134 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13135 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13136 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13137 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13138 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13139 of backends use the same servers.
13140
13141 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13142
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013143agent-addr <addr>
13144 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13145
13146 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13147 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13148 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13149 hostname, it will be resolved.
13150
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013151agent-port <port>
13152 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13153
13154 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13155
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013156allow-0rtt
13157 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013158 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13159 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013160
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013161alpn <protocols>
13162 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13163 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13164 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013165 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013166 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13167 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13168 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13169 now obsolete NPN extension.
13170 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13171 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13172
13173 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013175backup
13176 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13177 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13178 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13179 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013180 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13181 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013182
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013183ca-file <cafile>
13184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13185 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13186 server's certificate.
13187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013188check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013189 This option enables health checks on a server:
13190 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13191 considered available.
13192 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13193 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13194 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13195 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13196 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13197 set.
13198 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13199 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13200 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13201 exchanges succeed.
13202
13203 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13204 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13205 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13206 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13207 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013208 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013209 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13210
13211 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13212 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13213
13214 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13215 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13216
13217 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13218 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13219 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13220 available.
13221
13222 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13223 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13224 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13225
13226 Example:
13227 # simple tcp check
13228 backend foo
13229 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13230 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13231 backend foo
13232 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13233 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13234 backend foo
13235 option tcp-check
13236 tcp-check connect
13237 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013238
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013239check-send-proxy
13240 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13241 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13242 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13243 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13244 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13245 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13246 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13247
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013248check-alpn <protocols>
13249 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13250 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13251 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13252
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013253check-proto <name>
13254 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13255 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13256 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13257 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013258 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013259 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13260 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13261
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013262check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013263 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013264 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13265 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013266
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013267check-ssl
13268 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13269 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13270 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13271 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013272 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013273 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13274 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013275 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013276 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13277 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013278
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013279check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013280 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013281 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13282 for normal traffic.
13283
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013284ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13286 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13287 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013288 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13289 information and recommendations see e.g.
13290 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13291 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13292 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013293
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013294ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13296 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13297 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13298 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013299 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13300 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13301 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013303cookie <value>
13304 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13305 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13306 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13307 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13308 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13309 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13310 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13311
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013312crl-file <crlfile>
13313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13314 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13315 to verify server's certificate.
13316
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013317crt <cert>
13318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13319 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13320 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13321 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13322 certificate request.
13323
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013324disabled
13325 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13326 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13327 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13328 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13329 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013330 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013331
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013332enabled
13333 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13334 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13335 default value.
13336 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13337 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013339error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013340 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13341 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13342 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013344 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013346fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013347 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13348 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13349 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13350
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013351force-sslv3
13352 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13353 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013354 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013355 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013356
13357force-tlsv10
13358 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013359 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013360 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013361
13362force-tlsv11
13363 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013364 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013365 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013366
13367force-tlsv12
13368 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013369 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013370 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013371
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013372force-tlsv13
13373 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13374 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013375 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013377id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013378 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13379 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13380 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013381
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013382init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13383 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13384 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013385 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013386 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13387 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13388 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13389 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13390 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13391 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13392 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13393 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13394 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013395 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013396 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13397 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13398 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13399 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13400 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13401 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013402 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013403
13404 Example:
13405 defaults
13406 # never fail on address resolution
13407 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013409inter <delay>
13410fastinter <delay>
13411downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013412 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13413 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13414 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13415 between checks depending on the server state :
13416
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013417 Server state | Interval used
13418 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13419 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13420 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13421 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13422 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13423 or yet unchecked. |
13424 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13425 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13426 | "inter" otherwise.
13427 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013429 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13430 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13431 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13432 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013433 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13434 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13435 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13436 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13437 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013438
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013439log-proto <logproto>
13440 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13441 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13442 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13443 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013445maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013446 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13447 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013448 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13449 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013450 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13451 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13452 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13453 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13454
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013455 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13456 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13457 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13458 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13459 than 50 concurrent requests.
13460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013461maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013462 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13463 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13464 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13465 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13466 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13467 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13468 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13469
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013470max-reuse <count>
13471 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13472 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13473 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13474 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13475 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13476 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13477 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13478 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013480minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013481 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13482 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13483 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13484 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13485 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13486 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013487 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013488 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013489
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013490namespace <name>
13491 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13492 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13493 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13494 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13495
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013496no-agent-check
13497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13499 default value.
13500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13501 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13502
13503no-backup
13504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13506 default value.
13507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13508 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13509
13510no-check
13511 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13512 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13513 default value.
13514 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13515 "default-server" "check" setting.
13516
13517no-check-ssl
13518 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13519 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13520 default value.
13521 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13522 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13523
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013524no-send-proxy
13525 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13526 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13527 default value.
13528 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13529 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13530
13531no-send-proxy-v2
13532 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13533 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13534 default value.
13535 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13536 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13537
13538no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13539 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13540 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13541 default value.
13542 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13543 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13544
13545no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13546 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13547 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13548 default value.
13549 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13550 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13551
13552no-ssl
13553 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13554 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13555 default value.
13556 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13557 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13558
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013559no-ssl-reuse
13560 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13561 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13562 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13563 and for paranoid users.
13564
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013565no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013566 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13567 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013568 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013569
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013570 Supported in default-server: No
13571
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013572no-tls-tickets
13573 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13574 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13575 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013576 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13577 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013578 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13579 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13580 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013581 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013582
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013583no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013584 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013585 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13586 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013587 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13588 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013589 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013590
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013591 Supported in default-server: No
13592
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013593no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013594 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013595 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13596 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013597 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13598 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013599 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013600
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013601 Supported in default-server: No
13602
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013603no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013604 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013605 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13606 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013607 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13608 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013609 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013610
13611 Supported in default-server: No
13612
13613no-tlsv13
13614 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13615 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13616 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13617 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13618 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013619 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013620
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013621 Supported in default-server: No
13622
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013623no-verifyhost
13624 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13625 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13626 default value.
13627 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13628 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013629
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013630no-tfo
13631 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13632 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13633 default value.
13634 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13635 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13636
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013637non-stick
13638 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13639 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13640 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13641
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013642npn <protocols>
13643 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13644 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13645 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013646 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013647 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13648 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13649 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013651observe <mode>
13652 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13653 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13654 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13655 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13656 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13657 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013658 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013659
13660 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013662on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013663 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13664 Currently, four modes are available:
13665 - fastinter: force fastinter
13666 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13667 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13668 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13669 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13670
13671 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13672
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013673on-marked-down <action>
13674 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13675 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013676 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13677 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13678 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13679 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13680 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13681 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13682 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13683 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013684
13685 Actions are disabled by default
13686
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013687on-marked-up <action>
13688 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13689 Currently one action is available:
13690 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13691 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13692 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13693 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013694 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13695 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013696 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13697 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13698
13699 Actions are disabled by default
13700
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013701pool-low-conn <max>
13702 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13703 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13704 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13705 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13706 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13707 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13708 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13709 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13710 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13711 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13712 applying to "http-reuse".
13713
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013714pool-max-conn <max>
13715 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13716 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13717 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13718 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13719 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13720 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13721
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013722pool-purge-delay <delay>
13723 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013724 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013725 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013727port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013728 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13729 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13730 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13731 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13732 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13733 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13734
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013735proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013736 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13737 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13738 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13739 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013740 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013741 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013743redir <prefix>
13744 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13745 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13746 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13747 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13748 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13749 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13750 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13751 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013752 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013753 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013754 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13755 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13756 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13757 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13758
13759 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013761rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013762 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13763 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13764 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13765
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013766resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13767 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13768 server.
13769
13770 Available options:
13771
13772 * allow-dup-ip
13773 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13774 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13775 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13776 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13777 For such case, simply enable this option.
13778 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13779
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013780 * ignore-weight
13781 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13782 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13783 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13784
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013785 * prevent-dup-ip
13786 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13787 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13788 same fqdn.
13789 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13790
13791 Example:
13792 backend b_myapp
13793 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13794 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13795 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13796
13797 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13798 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13799 it
13800 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13801 different address
13802
13803 Default value: not set
13804
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013805resolve-prefer <family>
13806 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13807 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13808 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13809 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13810
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013811 Default value: ipv6
13812
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013813 Example:
13814
13815 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013816
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013817resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013818 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013819 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013820 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013821 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13822 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013823 configured network, another address is selected.
13824
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013825 Example:
13826
13827 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013828
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013829resolvers <id>
13830 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13831 hostname.
13832
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013833 Example:
13834
13835 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013836
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013837 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013838
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013839send-proxy
13840 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13841 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13842 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13843 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013844 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13845 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13846 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13847 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13848 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13849 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13850 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13851 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13852 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13853 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013854 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13855 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013856
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013857send-proxy-v2
13858 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13859 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13860 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13861 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013862 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13863 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13864 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13865 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013866
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013867proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013868 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13869 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13870
13871 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13872 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13873 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13874 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13875 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13876 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13877 connection is supported).
13878 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13879 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13880 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13881 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13882 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13883 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13884 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013885
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013886send-proxy-v2-ssl
13887 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13888 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13889 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13890 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13891 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13892 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13893 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013894 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13895 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013896
13897send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13898 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13899 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13900 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13901 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13902 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13903 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13904 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13905 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013906 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13907 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013909slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013910 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13911 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13912 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13913 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13914 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13915 parameters :
13916
13917 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13918 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13919
13920 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13921 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13922 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13923 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13924
13925 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13926 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13927 seen as failed.
13928
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013929sni <expression>
13930 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13931 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13932 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13933 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013934 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13935 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013936 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013937 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13938 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013939
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013940source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013941source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013942source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013943 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13944 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13945 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13946 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13947
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013948 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13949 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13950 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13951 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13952 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13953 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13954 server.
13955
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013956 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13957 specifying the source address without port(s).
13958
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013959ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013960 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13961 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13962 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13963 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13964 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13965 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013966 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13967 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013968
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013969ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13970 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13971 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13972 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13973
13974ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13975 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13976 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13977 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13978
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013979ssl-reuse
13980 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13981 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13982 default value.
13983 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13984 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13985
13986stick
13987 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13988 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13989 default value.
13990 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13991 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013992
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013993socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013994 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013995 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13996 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13997
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013998tcp-ut <delay>
13999 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14000 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14001 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014002 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014003 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14004 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14005 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14006 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14007 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14008 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14009 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14010 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14011 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14012
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014013tfo
14014 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14015 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14016 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14017 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14018 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014019 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014021track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014022 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14023 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14024 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14025 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014026 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14027
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014028tls-tickets
14029 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14030 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14031 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014032 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14033 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14034 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014035 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014036 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014037
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014038verify [none|required]
14039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014040 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014041 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14042 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014043 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014044 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14045 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14046 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14047 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14048 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14049 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14050 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14051 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014052
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014053verifyhost <hostname>
14054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014055 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14056 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14057 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14058 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14059 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14060 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14061 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14062 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014064weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014065 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14066 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14067 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014068 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14069 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14070 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14071 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14072 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14073 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014074
14075
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140765.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14077-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014078
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014079HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14080using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14081configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014082This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14083can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14084workload.
14085This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14086resolution at run time.
14087Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14088carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14089
14090
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140915.3.1. Global overview
14092----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014093
14094As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14095different steps of the process life:
14096
14097 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14098 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14099 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14100
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014101 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14102 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014103
14104A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14105 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14106 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14107 resolution to know this new IP.
14108
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014109When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014110HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014111SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14112from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14113will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14114will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014115
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014116A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014117 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014118 first valid response.
14119
14120 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14121 servers return an error.
14122
14123
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141245.3.2. The resolvers section
14125----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014126
14127This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014128HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14129contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014130
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014131When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14132uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14133is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14134answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14135
14136When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014137used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014138
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014139 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14140 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14141 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014142
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014143 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14144 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014145
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014146 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14147 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14148 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014149
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014150For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14151following scenarios are possible:
14152
14153 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14154 ignored
14155
14156 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14157 applied
14158
14159 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14160 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14161
14162 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14163 retries the query with a new type
14164
14165 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14166 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014167
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014168As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14169a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014170<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014171
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014172
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014173resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014174 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014175
14176A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14177
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014178accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014179 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014180 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014181 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14182 by RFC 6891)
14183
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014184 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14185
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014186nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14187 DNS server description:
14188 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14189 <ip> : IP address of the server
14190 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14191
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014192parse-resolv-conf
14193 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14194 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14195 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14196
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014197hold <status> <period>
14198 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14199 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014200 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014201 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014202 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14203 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14204 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14205
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014206 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014207
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014208resolve_retries <nb>
14209 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14210 giving up.
14211 Default value: 3
14212
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014213 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14214 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14215 type.
14216
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014217timeout <event> <time>
14218 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14219 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14220 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014221 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14222 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014223 Default value: 1s
14224 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014225 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014226 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014227 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14228 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14229
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014230 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014231
14232 resolvers mydns
14233 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14234 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014235 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014236 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014237 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014238 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014239 hold other 30s
14240 hold refused 30s
14241 hold nx 30s
14242 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014243 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014244 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014245
14246
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142476. Cache
14248---------
14249
14250HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14251(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14252RAM.
14253
14254The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14255this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14256
14257If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14258independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14259when we try to allocate a new one.
14260
14261The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14262
14263It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14264"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14265for more details.
14266
14267When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14268replaced by "<CACHE>".
14269
14270
142716.1. Limitation
14272----------------
14273
14274The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14275
14276- If the response is not a 200
14277- If the response contains a Vary header
14278- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14279- If the response is not cacheable
14280
14281- If the request is not a GET
14282- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14283- If the request contains an Authorization header
14284
14285
142866.2. Setup
14287-----------
14288
14289To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14290the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14291
14292
142936.2.1. Cache section
14294---------------------
14295
14296cache <name>
14297 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14298 size of cache is mandatory.
14299
14300total-max-size <megabytes>
14301 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14302 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14303
14304max-object-size <bytes>
14305 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14306 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14307 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14308
14309max-age <seconds>
14310 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14311 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14312 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14313 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14314 default.
14315
14316
143176.2.2. Proxy section
14318---------------------
14319
14320http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14321 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14322 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14323 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14324 after this one.
14325
14326http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14327 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14328 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14329 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14330 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14331
14332
14333Example:
14334
14335 backend bck1
14336 mode http
14337
14338 http-request cache-use foobar
14339 http-response cache-store foobar
14340 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14341
14342 cache foobar
14343 total-max-size 4
14344 max-age 240
14345
14346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143477. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14348----------------------------------
14349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014350HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14352The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14353these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14354but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14355data called patterns.
14356
14357
143587.1. ACL basics
14359---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014360
14361The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14362content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14363from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14364simple :
14365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014366 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014367 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14369 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14372adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373
14374In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014376 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014377
14378This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14379Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14380and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014381an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14382conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14383as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14384are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014385
14386ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14387'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14388which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14389
14390There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14391performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014393The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14394specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14395this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014396methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14397ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398
14399Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14400 - boolean
14401 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14402 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14403 - string
14404 - data block
14405
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014406Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14407converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14408would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14409The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14410which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14411
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014412Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14413keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14414fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14415which are summarized in the table below :
14416
14417 +---------------------+-----------------+
14418 | Sample or converter | Default |
14419 | output type | matching method |
14420 +---------------------+-----------------+
14421 | boolean | bool |
14422 +---------------------+-----------------+
14423 | integer | int |
14424 +---------------------+-----------------+
14425 | ip | ip |
14426 +---------------------+-----------------+
14427 | string | str |
14428 +---------------------+-----------------+
14429 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14430 +---------------------+-----------------+
14431
14432Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14433matching method, see below.
14434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14436 - boolean
14437 - integer or integer range
14438 - IP address / network
14439 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14440 - regular expression
14441 - hex block
14442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014443The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14444
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014445 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14446 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014448 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014449 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014450 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014451 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014453The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14454read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14455if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14456lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14457will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14458beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14459a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14460lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14461exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14462
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014463The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14464parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14465ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14466a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14467check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14468
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014469The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14470socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14471file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014473Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14474loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14475
14476 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14477
14478In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14479the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14480case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14481as well.
14482
14483The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14484sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14485do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14486methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14487is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014488obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014489followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14490default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14491that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14492string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14493
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014494The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14495By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14496string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14497resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14498server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014499waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014500flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14501function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14504sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14505be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014506
14507 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14508 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14510 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14511 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14512 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014513
14514 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14515 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014517
14518 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014519 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014520
14521 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014522 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014523
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014524 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014525 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14526
14527 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14528 binary or string samples.
14529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14531 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14534 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14535 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14538 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14541 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14544 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14547 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014548 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14551 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14552 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014553
14554For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14555request, it is possible to do :
14556
14557 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14558
14559In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14560buffer, one would use the following acl :
14561
14562 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14563
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014564On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14565possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14566
14567 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14570criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14571method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14572to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14573criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14574the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014576If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014577the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14578For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14581 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14582 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14583 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014584
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014585
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014586The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14587types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14588combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14589brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14590default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014592 +-------------------------------------------------+
14593 | Input sample type |
14594 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014595 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014596 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14597 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14598 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014599 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014600 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014601 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014603 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014604 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014605 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014607 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014608 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014609 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014610 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014611 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014612 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014613 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014614 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014615 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014617 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014619 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14621 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014623
14624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146257.1.1. Matching booleans
14626------------------------
14627
14628In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14629Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14630When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14631that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14632
14633Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14634return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14635"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146387.1.2. Matching integers
14639------------------------
14640
14641Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14642enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14643to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14644
14645Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14646matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14647lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014648
14649For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14650unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14651representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14652
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014653As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14654two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14655instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14656ranges and operators.
14657
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014658For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014659operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14660Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14661of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014662
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014663Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014664
14665 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14666 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14667 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14668 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14669 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014671For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014672
14673 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14674
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014675This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14676
14677 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146807.1.3. Matching strings
14681-----------------------
14682
14683String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14684different forms :
14685
14686 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014687 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688
14689 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014690 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014691
14692 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14693 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14694
14695 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14696 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14697
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014698 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014699 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14700 matches.
14701
14702 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14703 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14704 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014705
14706String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14707exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14708characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14709string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14710to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014711before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014712
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014713Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14714(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14715Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14716
14717Example:
14718 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14719 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147227.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14723---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014724
14725Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14726they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14727possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14728passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14729the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014730the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14731match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014732
14733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147347.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14735-------------------------------------
14736
14737It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14738not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14739a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14740to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14741digits may be used upper or lower case.
14742
14743Example :
14744 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14745 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14746
14747
147487.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14749---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014750
14751IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14752netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14753within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014754host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014755difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14756at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14757does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14758parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014759
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014760The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14761abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14762
14763 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14764 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14765 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14766 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14767 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14768 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14769 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14770 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14771
14772Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14773192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14774
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014775IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14776Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14777trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14778IPv6 patterns.
14779
14780HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14781following situations :
14782 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14783 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14784 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14785 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14786 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14787 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14788 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14789 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14790 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14791 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793
147947.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14795----------------------------------
14796
14797Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14798combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14799
14800 - AND (implicit)
14801 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14802 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014806 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14809indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14812"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14813requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14814is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14815
14816 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014817 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14818 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14819 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820
14821To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14822and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14823
14824 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14825 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14826 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14827 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14828
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014829 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14831 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14832 use_backend www if host_www
14833
14834It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14835expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14836be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14837the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14838
14839 The following rule :
14840
14841 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014842 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843
14844 Can also be written that way :
14845
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014846 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014847
14848It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14849to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14850simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14851sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14852good use is the following :
14853
14854 With named ACLs :
14855
14856 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14857 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14858 monitor fail if site_dead
14859
14860 With anonymous ACLs :
14861
14862 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14863
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014864See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14865keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866
14867
148687.3. Fetching samples
14869---------------------
14870
14871Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14872against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14873sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14874ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14875of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14876available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14877
14878This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14879Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14880compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14881deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14882
14883The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14884matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14885method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14886indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14887
14888As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14889when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14890mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14891the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14892ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14893
14894Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14895multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14896when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014897incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14898are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14900all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14901
14902Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14903 - name
14904 - name(arg1)
14905 - name(arg1,arg2)
14906
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014907
149087.3.1. Converters
14909-----------------
14910
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014911Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14912of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14913is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14914was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014915has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014916unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14917
14918These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14919sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14920the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014921support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014922
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014923A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14924support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14925supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14926(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14927bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014930
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001493151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14932 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14933 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14934 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14935 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14936 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14937
14938 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014939 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14940 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014941 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14942 frontend http-in
14943 bind *:8081
14944 default_backend servers
14945 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14946 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14947
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014948add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014949 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014950 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014951 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14952 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014953 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014954 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14955 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14956 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14957 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014958 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014959 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014960
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014961aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14962 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14963 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14964 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14965 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14966 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14967 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14968
14969 Example:
14970 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14971 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14972
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014973and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014974 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014975 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014976 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14977 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014978 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014979 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14980 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14981 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14982 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014983 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014984 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014985
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014986b64dec
14987 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14988 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14989
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014990base64
14991 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014992 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014993 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14994
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014995bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014996 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014997 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014998 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014999 presence of a flag).
15000
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015001bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15002 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15003 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015004 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015005
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015006concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15007 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15008 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15009 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15010 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15011 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15012 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15013 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15014 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15015 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15016 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015017 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015018 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015019 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15020 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015021
15022 Example:
15023 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15024 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15025 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015026 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015027 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15028
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015029cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015030 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15031 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015032
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015033crc32([<avalanche>])
15034 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15035 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15036 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15037 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15038 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15039 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15040 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15041 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15042 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15043 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015044 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15045
15046crc32c([<avalanche>])
15047 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15048 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15049 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15050 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15051 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15052 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15053 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15054 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015055
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015056cut_crlf
15057 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15058 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15059 updated.
15060
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015061da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015062 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15063 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15064 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15065 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015066 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015067 configuration language.
15068
15069 Example:
15070 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015071 bind *:8881
15072 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015073 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015074
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015075debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15076 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15077 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15078 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15079 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15080 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15081 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15082 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15083 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15084 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15085 printable sample types.
15086
15087 Example:
15088 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015089
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015090digest(<algorithm>)
15091 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15092 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15093
15094 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15095 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15096
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015097div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015098 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15099 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015100 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015101 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15102 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015103 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015104 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15105 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15106 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15107 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015108 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015109 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015110
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015111djb2([<avalanche>])
15112 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15113 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15114 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15115 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15116 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15117 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15118 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015119 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15120 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015121
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015122even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015123 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015124 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15125
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015126field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15127 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15128 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15129 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15130 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15131 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15132 fields.
15133
15134 Example :
15135 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15136 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15137 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15138 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15139 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015140
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015141hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015142 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015143 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015144 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015145 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015146
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015147hex2i
15148 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015149 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015150
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015151htonl
15152 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15153 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15154 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15155 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15156
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015157hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15158 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15159 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15160 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15161 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15162
15163 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15164 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15165
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015166http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015167 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15168 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015169 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15170 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15171 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15172 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15173 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15174 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15175 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15176 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015178iif(<true>,<false>)
15179 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15180 string otherwise.
15181
15182 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015183 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015184
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015185in_table(<table>)
15186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15188 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015189 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015190 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15191
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015192ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15193 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015194 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015195 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15196 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15197 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15198 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15199 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015200
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015201json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015202 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015203 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015204 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015205 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15206 of errors:
15207 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15208 bytes, ...)
15209 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15210 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15211
15212 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15213 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15214 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15215 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15216 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15217 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015218 - "ascii" : never fails;
15219 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15220 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015221 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015222 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015223 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15224 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15225
15226 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015227 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015228
15229 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015230 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015231 capture request header user-agent len 150
15232 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015233
15234 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15235 GET / HTTP/1.0
15236 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15237
15238 Output log:
15239 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15240
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015241language(<value>[,<default>])
15242 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15243 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15244 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15245 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15246 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15247 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15248 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15249 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15250 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015252 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15253 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015254
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015255 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015256
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015257 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15258 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015259
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015260 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15261 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15262 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15263 use_backend spanish if es
15264 use_backend french if fr
15265 use_backend english if en
15266 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015267
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015268length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015269 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15270 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15271 type. The result is of type integer.
15272
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015273lower
15274 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15275 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15276 type. The result is of type string.
15277
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015278ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15279 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15280 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15281 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15282 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15283 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15284 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15285
15286 Example :
15287
15288 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015289 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015290 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15291
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015292ltrim(<chars>)
15293 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15294 representation of the input sample.
15295
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015296map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15297map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15298map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15299 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15300 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15301 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15302 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15303 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15304 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15305 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15306 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015307
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015308 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15309 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15310 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015311
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015312 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015313 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015315 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15316 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15317 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15318 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015319 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15320 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015321 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15322 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15323 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15324 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15325 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15326 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15327 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15328 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015329 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15330 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15331 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015332 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15333 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15334 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15335 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15336 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015337
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015338 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15339 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15340 the corresponding match text.
15341
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015342 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15343 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15344 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15345 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15346 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015347
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015348 Example :
15349
15350 # this is a comment and is ignored
15351 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15352 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15353 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15354 | | | `---------- value
15355 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15356 | `---------------------------- key
15357 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15358
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015359mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015360 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15361 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015362 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015363 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015364 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015365 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15366 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15367 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15368 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015369 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015370 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015371
15372mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015373 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015374 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15375 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015376 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015377 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015378 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015379 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15380 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15381 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15382 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015383 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015384 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015385
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015386nbsrv
15387 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15388 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15389 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15390 map lookup.
15391
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015392neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015393 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15394 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15395 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15396 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015397
15398not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015399 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015400 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015401 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015402 absence of a flag).
15403
15404odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015405 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015406 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15407
15408or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015409 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015410 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015411 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15412 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015413 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015414 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15415 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15416 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15417 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015418 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015419 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015420
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015421protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15422 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15423 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15424 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15425 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15426 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15427 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15428 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15429 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15430 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15431 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15432 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15433
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015434regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015435 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15436 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15437 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15438 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15439 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15440 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15441 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15442 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15443 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015444 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15445 of characters with other ones.
15446
15447 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15448 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15449 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15450 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15451 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15452 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015453
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015454 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015455
15456 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15457 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15458 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015459 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015460
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015461 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15462 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15463
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015464 # capture groups and backreferences
15465 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015466 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015467 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15468
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015469capture-req(<id>)
15470 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15471 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15472
15473 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015474 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15475 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015476
15477capture-res(<id>)
15478 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15479 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15480
15481 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015482 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15483 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015484
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015485rtrim(<chars>)
15486 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15487 of the input sample.
15488
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015489sdbm([<avalanche>])
15490 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15491 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15492 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15493 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15494 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15495 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15496 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015497 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15498 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015499
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015500secure_memcmp(<var>)
15501 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15502 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15503 match.
15504
15505 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15506 performed in constant time.
15507
15508 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15509 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15510
15511 Example :
15512
15513 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15514 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15515 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15516 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15517
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015518set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015519 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15520 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15521 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015522 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015523 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15524 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015525 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015526 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15527 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015528 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015529 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015530
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015531sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015532 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015533 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15534
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015535sha2([<bits>])
15536 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15537 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15538
15539 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15540 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15541
15542 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15543 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15544
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015545srv_queue
15546 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15547 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15548 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15549 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15550 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15551
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015552strcmp(<var>)
15553 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15554 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15555 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15556 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15557 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15558 shorter).
15559
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015560 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15561 strings in constant time.
15562
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015563 Example :
15564
15565 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15566 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15567 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15568
15569
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015570sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015571 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15572 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015573 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015574 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15575 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015576 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015577 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15578 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015579 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015580 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15581 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015582 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015583 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015584
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015585table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15586 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15587 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15588 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15589 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15590 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15591 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15592
15593
15594table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15595 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15596 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15597 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15598 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15599 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15600 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15601
15602table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15603 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15604 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015605 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015606 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15607 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15608
15609table_conn_cur(<table>)
15610 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15611 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15612 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15613 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15614 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15615
15616table_conn_rate(<table>)
15617 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15618 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15619 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15620 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15621 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15622
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015623table_gpt0(<table>)
15624 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15625 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15626 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15627 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15628 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15629
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015630table_gpc0(<table>)
15631 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15632 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15633 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15634 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15635 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15636
15637table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15638 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15639 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15640 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15641 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15642 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15643 sample fetch keyword.
15644
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015645table_gpc1(<table>)
15646 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15647 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15648 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15649 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15650 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15651
15652table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15653 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15654 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15655 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15656 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15657 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15658 sample fetch keyword.
15659
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015660table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15661 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15662 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015663 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015664 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15665 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15666
15667table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15670 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15671 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15672 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15673 keyword.
15674
15675table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15676 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15677 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015678 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015679 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15680 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15681
15682table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15683 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15684 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15685 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15686 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15687 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15688 keyword.
15689
15690table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15691 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15692 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015693 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015694 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15695 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15696 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15697 keyword.
15698
15699table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15700 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15701 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015702 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015703 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15704 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15705 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15706 keyword.
15707
15708table_server_id(<table>)
15709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15711 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15712 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15713 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15714 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15715
15716table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15717 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15718 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015719 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015720 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15721 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15722 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15723 keyword.
15724
15725table_sess_rate(<table>)
15726 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15727 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15728 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15729 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15730 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15731 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15732 keyword.
15733
15734table_trackers(<table>)
15735 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15736 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15737 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15738 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15739 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15740 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15741 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15742 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15743 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15744 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15745
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015746upper
15747 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15748 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15749 type. The result is of type string.
15750
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015751url_dec([<in_form>])
15752 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15753 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15754 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15755 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15756 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15757 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015758
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015759ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015760 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015761 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15762 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15763 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015764 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15765 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15766 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15767 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015768 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015769 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15770 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015771
15772 Example:
15773 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15774 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15775
15776 message Point {
15777 int32 latitude = 1;
15778 int32 longitude = 2;
15779 }
15780
15781 message PPoint {
15782 Point point = 59;
15783 }
15784
15785 message Rectangle {
15786 // One corner of the rectangle.
15787 PPoint lo = 48;
15788 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15789 PPoint hi = 49;
15790 }
15791
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015792 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15793 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15794 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015795
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015796 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15797 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015798 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015799 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15800
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015801 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015802
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015803 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015804
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015805 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15806 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15807 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015808
15809 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15810 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15811 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15812
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015813 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15814 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15815 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015816
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015817
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015818unset-var(<var name>)
15819 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15820 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15821 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15823 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15824 response),
15825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15826 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15827 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15828 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15829
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015830utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15831 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15832 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15833 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15834 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15835 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15836 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15837
15838 Example :
15839
15840 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015841 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015842 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15843
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015844word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15845 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15846 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15847 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015848 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015849 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15850 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15851
15852 Example :
15853 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15854 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15855 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15856 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15857 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015858 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015859
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015860wt6([<avalanche>])
15861 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15862 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15863 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15864 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15865 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15866 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15867 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015868 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15869 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015870
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015871xor(<value>)
15872 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015873 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015874 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015875 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015876 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015877 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15878 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015879 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015880 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15881 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015882 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015883 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015884
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015885xxh32([<seed>])
15886 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15887 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15888 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15889 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15890 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15891 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15892 as cryptographically secure.
15893
15894xxh64([<seed>])
15895 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15896 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15897 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15898 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15899 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15900 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15901 as cryptographically secure.
15902
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015903
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159047.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905--------------------------------------------
15906
15907A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15908not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15909"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15910The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15911
15912always_false : boolean
15913 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15914 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15915
15916always_true : boolean
15917 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15918 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15919
15920avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015921 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15923 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15924 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15925 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15926 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15927 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15928 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15929 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15930 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15931 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15932 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15933 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15934 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015937 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15938 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15939 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15940 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015941 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15942
15943be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15944 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15945 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15946 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15947 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15948 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015949 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15950 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015951
15952 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15953 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15954 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15957 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15958 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15959 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015960 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15962 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015963
15964 Example :
15965 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15966 backend dynamic
15967 mode http
15968 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15969 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015971bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015972 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15973 of the string.
15974
15975bool(<bool>) : bool
15976 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15977 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015981 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15983 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015984
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015985 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015986 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015987 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15988
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015989 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15990 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015991
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015992 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015993 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015994 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015995 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015996 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015998 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015999
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016000 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16001 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016003 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016004
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016005cpu_calls : integer
16006 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16007 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16008 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16009 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16010 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16011 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16012
16013cpu_ns_avg : integer
16014 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16015 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16016 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16017 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16018 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16019 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16020 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16021 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16022 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16023 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16024 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16025
16026cpu_ns_tot : integer
16027 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16028 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16029 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16030 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16031 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16032 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16033 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16034 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16035 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16036 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16037 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16038 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16039 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16040
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016041date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016042 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016043
16044 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16045 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16046 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016047 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16048
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016049 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16050 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16051 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16052 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16053 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16054
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016055 Example :
16056
16057 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16058 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016059
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016060 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16061 # millisecond granularity
16062 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16063
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016064date_us : integer
16065 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16066 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16067 from the same timeval structure.
16068
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016069distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16070 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16071 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16072 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16073 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16074 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16075 list of supported tokens.
16076
16077distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16078 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16079 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16080 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16081 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16082 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16083 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16084 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16085 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16086 supported tokens.
16087
16088 Example :
16089 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16090 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16091 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16092 # send large files to the big farm
16093 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16094
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016095env(<name>) : string
16096 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16097 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16098 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16099 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16100 certain way.
16101
16102 Examples :
16103 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16104 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16105
16106 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16107 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16110 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016111 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16112 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16114 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016115 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16117 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016118
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016119fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16120 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16121 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16122 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16125 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16126 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16127 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16128 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16129 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16130 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16131 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16132 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016133
16134 Example :
16135 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16136 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16137 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16138 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16139 frontend mail
16140 bind :25
16141 mode tcp
16142 maxconn 100
16143 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16144 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16145 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16146 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016147
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016148hostname : string
16149 Returns the system hostname.
16150
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016151int(<integer>) : signed integer
16152 Returns a signed integer.
16153
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016154ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16155 Returns an ipv4.
16156
16157ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16158 Returns an ipv6.
16159
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016160lat_ns_avg : integer
16161 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16162 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16163 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16164 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16165 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16166 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16167 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16168 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16169 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016170 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16171 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16172 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16173 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16174 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16175 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016176
16177lat_ns_tot : integer
16178 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16179 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16180 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16181 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16182 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16183 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16184 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16185 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16186 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016187 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16188 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16189 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16190 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16191 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016192 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16193 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16194 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16195 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16196 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16197 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16198
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016199meth(<method>) : method
16200 Returns a method.
16201
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016202nbproc : integer
16203 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16204 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16205 and debugging purposes.
16206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016207nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16208 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16209 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16210 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016211 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16212 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16213 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016214
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016215prio_class : integer
16216 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16217 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16218 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16219
16220prio_offset : integer
16221 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16222 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16223 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16224 set-priority-offset".
16225
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016226proc : integer
16227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16228 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16229 debugging purposes.
16230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016232 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16233 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16234 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16236 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16237 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16238 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16239 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16240
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016241rand([<range>]) : integer
16242 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16243 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16244 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16245 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16246 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16247
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016248uuid([<version>]) : string
16249 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16250 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16251 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16254 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16255 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16256 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16257 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16258 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016259 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16260 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16261
16262srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16263 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16264 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16265 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16266 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16267 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16268 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16269 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16270
16271 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16272 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273
16274srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16275 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16276 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16277 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016278 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16280 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16281 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16282
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016283srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16284 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16285 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16286 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16287 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16288 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16289 fetch methods.
16290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16292 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16293 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016294 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16296 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016297 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016298 overloading servers).
16299
16300 Example :
16301 # Redirect to a separate back
16302 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16303 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16304 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16305
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016306srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16307 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16308 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16309 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16310
16311srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16312 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16313 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16314 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16315
16316srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16317 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16318 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16319 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16320
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016321stopping : boolean
16322 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16323 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16324 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16325
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016326str(<string>) : string
16327 Returns a string.
16328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016329table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16330 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16331 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16332
16333table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16334 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16335 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16336 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16337
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016338thread : integer
16339 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16340 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16341 and debugging purposes.
16342
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016343var(<var-name>) : undefined
16344 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016345 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16346 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016347 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016348 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16349 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016350 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016351 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16352 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016354 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016355
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163567.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016357----------------------------------
16358
16359The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16360closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16361methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16362sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16363TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016364the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16365counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016366"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16367used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16368can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16369Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16370table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16371tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16372currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016374bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016375 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16376 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16377 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016379be_id : integer
16380 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016381 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16382 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016383
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016384be_name : string
16385 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016386 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16387 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389dst : ip
16390 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16391 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16392 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16393 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016394 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16395 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16396 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16397 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16398 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16399 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400
16401dst_conn : integer
16402 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16403 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16404 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16405 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16406 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16407 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16408 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16409 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016410
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016411dst_is_local : boolean
16412 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16413 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16414 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16415 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016416 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016417 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16418 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16419 it only once per connection.
16420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421dst_port : integer
16422 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16423 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16424 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16425 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16426 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16427 an HTTP header.
16428
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016429fc_http_major : integer
16430 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16431 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16432 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16433
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016434fc_pp_authority : string
16435 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16436 if any.
16437
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016438fc_pp_unique_id : string
16439 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16440 if any.
16441
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016442fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16443 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16444 header.
16445
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016446fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16447 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16448 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16449 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16450 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16451 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16452 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16453
16454fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16455 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16456 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16457 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16458 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16459 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16460 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16461
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016462fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016463 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16464 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16465 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16466 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16467
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016468fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016469 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16470 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16471 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16472 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16473
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016474fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016475 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16476 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16477 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16478 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16479
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016480fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016481 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16482 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16483 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16484 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16485
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016486fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016487 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16488 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16489 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16490 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16491
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016492fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016493 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16494 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16495 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16496 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16497
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016498fe_defbe : string
16499 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16500 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502fe_id : integer
16503 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016504 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16506
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016507fe_name : string
16508 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16509 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16510 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16511
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016512sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016513sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16514sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16515sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016516 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16517 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16518 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16519
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016520sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016521sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16522sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16523sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016524 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16525 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16526 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16527
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016528sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016529sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16530sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16531sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016532 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16533 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016534 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16535 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16536 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016537
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016538 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016539 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16540 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016541 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16542 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16543 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016544 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16545 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16546
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016547sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16548sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16549sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16550sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16551 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16552 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16553 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16554 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16555 when a first ACL was verified.
16556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016557sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016558sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16559sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16560sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016561 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016562 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16563
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016564sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016565sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16566sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16567sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016568 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16569 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16570 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16571
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016572sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016573sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16574sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16575sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016576 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16577 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16578 See also src_conn_rate.
16579
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016580sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016581sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16582sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16583sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016584 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016585 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016586
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016587sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16588sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16589sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16590sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16591 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16592 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16593
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016594sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16595sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16596sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16597sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16598 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16599 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16600
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016601sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016602sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16603sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16604sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016605 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16606 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16607 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016608 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16609 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16610 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016611
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016612sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16613sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16614sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16615sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16616 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16617 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16618 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16619 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16620 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16621 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16622
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016623sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016624sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16625sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16626sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016627 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016628 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16629 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016631sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016632sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16633sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16634sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016635 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16636 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16637 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16638 src_http_err_rate.
16639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016640sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016641sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16642sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16643sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016644 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016645 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16646 src_http_req_cnt.
16647
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016648sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016649sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16650sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16651sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016652 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16653 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16654 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16655 src_http_req_rate.
16656
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016657sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016658sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16659sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16660sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016661 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016662 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16663 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16664 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16665 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016666
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016667 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016668 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16669 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016670 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16671
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016672sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16673sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16674sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16675sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16676 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16677 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16678 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16679 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16680 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16681
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016682sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016683sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16684sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16685sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016686 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16687 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16688 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016689
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016690sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016691sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16692sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16693sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016694 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16695 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16696 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016697
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016698sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016699sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16700sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16701sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016702 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016703 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16704 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16705 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016706 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016707 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016709sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016710sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16711sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16712sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016713 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16714 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16715 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16716 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16717 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016718 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016719
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016720sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016721sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16722sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16723sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016724 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16725 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16726 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16727
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016728sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016729sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16730sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16731sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016732 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16733 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016734 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016735 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16736 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16738 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16739 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016741so_id : integer
16742 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16743 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16744 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016745
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016746so_name : string
16747 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16748 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16749 strings instead of integers.
16750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016751src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016752 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016753 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16754 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16755 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016756 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16757 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16758 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016759 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16760 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16761 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16762 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16763 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16764 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16765 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016766
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016767 Example:
16768 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16769 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16772 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16773 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16774 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016775 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016777src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16778 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16779 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016780 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016781 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016783src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16784 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16785 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16786 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16787 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16788 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16789 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016790
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016791 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016792 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16793 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16794 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16795 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016796 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016797 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16798 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16799
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016800src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16801 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16802 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16803 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16804 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16805 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16806 was verified.
16807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016809 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016811 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016812 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016815 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16817 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016818 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16821 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16822 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16823 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016824 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016827 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016829 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016830 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016831
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016832src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16833 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16834 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16835 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16836 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16837
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016838src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16839 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16840 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16841 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16842 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016844src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016845 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016847 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16848 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016849 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16850 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16851 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016852
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016853src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16854 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16855 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16856 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16857 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16858 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16859 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16860 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016863 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016865 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016866 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16870 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16871 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16872 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16873 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016874 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016877 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16879 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016880 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16883 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16884 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16885 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016886 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016887 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16890 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16891 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16892 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016893 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16895 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016896
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016897 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016898 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016899 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016900 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016901
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016902src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16903 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16904 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16905 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16906 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16907 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16908 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16909
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016910src_is_local : boolean
16911 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16912 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16913 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16914 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016915 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016916 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16917 once per connection.
16918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016920 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16921 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16922 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16923 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16924 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016927 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16928 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16929 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16930 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16931 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933src_port : integer
16934 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16935 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16936 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16937 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016940 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016941 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16942 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16943 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016944 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16947 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16948 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16949 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16950 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016951 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16954 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16955 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16956 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16957 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16958 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16959 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16960 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16961 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016962
16963 Example :
16964 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16965 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16966 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16967 listen ssh
16968 bind :22
16969 mode tcp
16970 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016971 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016972 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016973 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975srv_id : integer
16976 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16977 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016978 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016979
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016980srv_name : string
16981 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16982 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016983 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169857.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016986----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016988The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16989closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16990when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16991usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016992future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016993
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001699451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16995 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16996 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16997 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16998 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16999 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17000
17001 Example :
17002 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17003 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17004 # the request.
17005 frontend http-in
17006 bind *:8081
17007 default_backend servers
17008 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17009 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17010
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017011ssl_bc : boolean
17012 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17013 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017014 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17015 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017016
17017ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17018 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017019 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17020 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017021
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017022ssl_bc_alpn : string
17023 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17024 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017025 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017026 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17027 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17028 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17029 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17030 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017031 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17032 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017033
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017034ssl_bc_cipher : string
17035 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017036 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17037 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017038
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017039ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17040 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17041 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17042 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017043 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017044
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017045ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17046 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17047 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017048 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17049 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017050
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017051ssl_bc_npn : string
17052 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17053 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017054 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017055 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17056 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17057 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17058 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017059 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17060 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017061
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017062ssl_bc_protocol : string
17063 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017064 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17065 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017066
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017067ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017068 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017069 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017070 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17071 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017072
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017073ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17074 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17075 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17076 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017077 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017078
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017079ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17080 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17081 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017082 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17083 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017084
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017085ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17086 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17087 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17088 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017089 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017090
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017091ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17092 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017093 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17094 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17097 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17098 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17099 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17100 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17101 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017103ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17104 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17105 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17106 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17107 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017108
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017109ssl_c_der : binary
17110 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17111 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17112 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17113
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017114ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17115 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17116 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17117 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17118 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17119 does not support resumed sessions.
17120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017121ssl_c_err : integer
17122 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17123 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17124 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17125 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17126 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017127
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017128ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017129 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17130 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17131 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17132 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17133 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17134 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17135 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17136 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017137 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17138 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17139 LDAP v3.
17140 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17141 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017143ssl_c_key_alg : string
17144 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17145 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17146 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017148ssl_c_notafter : string
17149 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17150 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17151 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017153ssl_c_notbefore : string
17154 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17155 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17156 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017157
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017158ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017159 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17160 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17161 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17162 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17163 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17164 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17165 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17166 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017167 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17168 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17169 LDAP v3.
17170 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17171 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017173ssl_c_serial : binary
17174 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17175 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17176 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17179 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17180 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17181 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017182 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17183 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17184
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017185 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017186 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017188ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17189 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17190 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17191 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193ssl_c_used : boolean
17194 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17195 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017197ssl_c_verify : integer
17198 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17199 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17200 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17201 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017203ssl_c_version : integer
17204 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17205 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017206
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017207ssl_f_der : binary
17208 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17209 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17210 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17211
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017212ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017213 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17214 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17215 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17216 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017217 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017218 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17219 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17220 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017221 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17222 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17223 LDAP v3.
17224 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17225 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017227ssl_f_key_alg : string
17228 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17229 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17230 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017232ssl_f_notafter : string
17233 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17234 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17235 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017237ssl_f_notbefore : string
17238 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17239 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17240 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017241
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017242ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017243 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17244 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17245 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17246 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17247 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17248 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17249 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17250 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017251 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17252 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17253 LDAP v3.
17254 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17255 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257ssl_f_serial : binary
17258 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17259 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17260 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017261
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017262ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17263 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17264 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17265 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17268 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17269 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17270 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272ssl_f_version : integer
17273 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17274 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17275
17276ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017277 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17278 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17279 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281 Example :
17282 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17283 listen http-https
17284 bind :80
17285 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17286 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17287
17288ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17289 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17290 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17291
17292ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017293 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017294 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17295 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17296 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17297 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17298 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17299 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17300 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17301 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017303ssl_fc_cipher : string
17304 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17305 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017306
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017307ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17308 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17309 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017310 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017311
17312ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17313 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17314 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017315 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017316
17317ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17318 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17319 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17320 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017321 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017322 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017323
17324ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17325 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17326 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017327 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017328
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017329ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17330 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17331 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17332 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17333
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017334ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17335 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17336 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17337 transport layer.
17338 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17339 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17340 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17341 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17342
17343ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17344 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17345 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17346 transport layer.
17347 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17348 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17349 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17350 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17351
17352ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17353 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17354 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17355 transport layer.
17356 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17357 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17358 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17359 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17360
17361ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17362 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17363 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17364 transport layer.
17365 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17366 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17367 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17368 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17369
17370ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17371 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17372 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17373 transport layer.
17374 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17375 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17376 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17377 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017379ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017380 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17381 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017382 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17383 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17384 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17385 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017386
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017387ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17388 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17389 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17390 wait until the handshake happened.
17391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17393 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017394 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17395 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017396 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017397 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017398
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017399ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017400 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017401 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17402 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017404ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017405 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017406 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17407 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17408 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17409 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17410 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17411 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17412 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414ssl_fc_protocol : string
17415 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17416 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017417
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017418ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017419 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017420 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17421 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017422
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017423ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17424 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17425 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17426 transport layer.
17427 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17428 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17429 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17430 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17431
17432ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17433 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17434 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17435 transport layer.
17436 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17437 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17438 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17439 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17440
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017441ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17442 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17443 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17444 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17447 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17448 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17449 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17450 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017451
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017452ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17453 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17454 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17455 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17456 BoringSSL.
17457
17458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459ssl_fc_sni : string
17460 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17461 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17462 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17463 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17464 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17465
17466 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17467 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17468 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017469 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017470 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017472 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017473 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17474 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17477 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17478 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017479
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017480ssl_s_der : binary
17481 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17482 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17483 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17484
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017485ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17486 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17487 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17488 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17489 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17490 does not support resumed sessions.
17491
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017492ssl_s_key_alg : string
17493 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17494 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17495 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17496
17497ssl_s_notafter : string
17498 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17499 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17500 transport layer.
17501
17502ssl_s_notbefore : string
17503 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17504 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17505 transport layer.
17506
17507ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17508 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17509 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17510 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17511 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17512 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17513 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017514 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17515 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017516 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17517 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17518 LDAP v3.
17519 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17520 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17521
17522ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17523 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17524 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17525 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17526 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17527 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17528 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017529 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17530 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017531 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17532 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17533 LDAP v3.
17534 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17535 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17536
17537ssl_s_serial : binary
17538 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17539 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17540 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17541
17542ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17543 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17544 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17545 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17546
17547ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17548 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17549 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17550 layer.
17551
17552ssl_s_version : integer
17553 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17554 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175567.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017559Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17560sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17561only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17562For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17563be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17564can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17565sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17566for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17567content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017569payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017570 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017571 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17572 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17575 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017576 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017578
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017579req.hdrs : string
17580 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17581 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17582 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17583 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17584
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017585req.hdrs_bin : binary
17586 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17587 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17588 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17589 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17590 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17591 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17592
17593 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17594
17595 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17596 str: <int:length><bytes>
17597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598req.len : integer
17599req_len : integer (deprecated)
17600 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17601 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17602 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17603 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17604 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17605 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17606 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17607 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017609req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17610 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017611 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17612 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17613 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17614 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616 ACL alternatives :
17617 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017619req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17620 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17621 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17622 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17623 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017625 ACL alternatives :
17626 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017628 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017630req.proto_http : boolean
17631req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17632 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17633 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17634 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17635 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17636 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17637 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17638 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017640 Example:
17641 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17642 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17643 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017644 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017646req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17647rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17648 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17649 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17650 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17651 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17652 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17653 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17654 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017656 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17657 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17658 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17659 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17660 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17661 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663 ACL derivatives :
17664 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017666 Example :
17667 listen tse-farm
17668 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17669 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17670 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17671 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17672 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17673 persist rdp-cookie
17674 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17675 # This is only useful makes sense if
17676 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17677 stick-table type string size 204800
17678 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17679 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17680 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17683 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17686rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17687 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17688 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17689 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17690 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017692 ACL derivatives :
17693 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017694
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017695req.ssl_alpn : string
17696 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17697 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17698 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17699 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17700 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17701 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017702 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017703
17704 Examples :
17705 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17706 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17707 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017708 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017709 default_backend bk_default
17710
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017711req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17712 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17713 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017714 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17715 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17716 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17717 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17718 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017720req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17721req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17722 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17723 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17724 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17725 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17726 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17727 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17728 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730req.ssl_sni : string
17731req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17732 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17733 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17734 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17735 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17736 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017737 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17738 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17739 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17740 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17741 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17742 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17743 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17744 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17745 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747 ACL derivatives :
17748 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017750 Examples :
17751 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17752 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17753 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17754 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17755 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017756
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017757req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17758 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17759 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17760 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17761 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17762 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17763 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17764 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17765 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17766 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017768req.ssl_ver : integer
17769req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17770 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17771 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17772 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17773 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17774 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17775 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17776 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017777 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017778 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017780 ACL derivatives :
17781 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017782
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017783res.len : integer
17784 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17785 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17786 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17787 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17788 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17789 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17790 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017791 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017793res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17794 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017795 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017796 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017797 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017798 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017800res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17801 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17802 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17803 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017804 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17805 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017807 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017808
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017809res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17810rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17811 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17812 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17813 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17814 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17815 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17816 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17817 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819wait_end : boolean
17820 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17821 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017822 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017823 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17824 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017825 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017826 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17827 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829 Examples :
17830 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17831 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17832 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017834 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17835 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17836 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17837 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17838 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17839 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17840 tcp-request content reject
17841
17842
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178437.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017844--------------------------------------
17845
17846It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17847This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17848data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17849its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17850HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17851content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17852to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17853more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17854response are indexed.
17855
17856base : string
17857 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17858 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17859 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17860 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17861 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17862 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17863 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17864 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17865
17866 ACL derivatives :
17867 base : exact string match
17868 base_beg : prefix match
17869 base_dir : subdir match
17870 base_dom : domain match
17871 base_end : suffix match
17872 base_len : length match
17873 base_reg : regex match
17874 base_sub : substring match
17875
17876base32 : integer
17877 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17878 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17879 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017880 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17881 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17882 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883
17884base32+src : binary
17885 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17886 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17887 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17888 per-URL counters.
17889
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017890capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17891 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17892 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17893 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17894
17895capture.req.method : string
17896 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17897 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17898 because it's allocated.
17899
17900capture.req.uri : string
17901 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17902 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17903 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17904 allocated.
17905
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017906capture.req.ver : string
17907 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17908 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17909 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17910
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017911capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17912 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17913 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17914 The first entry is an index of 0.
17915 See also: "capture response header"
17916
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017917capture.res.ver : string
17918 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17919 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17920 persistent flag.
17921
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017922req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017923 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17924 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17925 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017926
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017927req.body_param([<name>) : string
17928 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17929 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17930 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17931 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17932 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17933 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17934 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17935 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17936 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17937 given.
17938
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017939req.body_len : integer
17940 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17941 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017942 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17943 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017944
17945req.body_size : integer
17946 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017947 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17948 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017950req.cook([<name>]) : string
17951cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17952 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17953 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17954 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17955 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17956 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17957 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17958 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17959 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17960
17961 ACL derivatives :
17962 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17963 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17964 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17965 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17966 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17967 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17968 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17969 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17972cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17973 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17974 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017976req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17977cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17978 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17979 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17980 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17981 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017983cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17984 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17985 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17986 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17987 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017988 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17990 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17991 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17992 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017994hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17995 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17996 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17997 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17998 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017999 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18002 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18003 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18004 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18005 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18006 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18007 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18008 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18009 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018011req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18012 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18013 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18014 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18015 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18018 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18019 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18020 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18021 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18022 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18023 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18024 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18025 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018026 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018027 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018028 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018030 ACL derivatives :
18031 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18032 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18033 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18034 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18035 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18036 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18037 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18038 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18039
18040req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18041hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18042 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18043 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18044 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18045 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18046 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18047 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18048 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18049 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18050 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18051
18052req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18053hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18054 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18055 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18056 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18057 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18058 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018059 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018060 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18061 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18062
18063req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18064hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18065 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18066 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18067 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18068 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18069 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18070 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18071 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18072
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018073
18074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018075http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18076 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18077 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18078 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18079 basic auth is supported.
18080
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018081http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18082 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18083 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18084 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18085 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018086 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18087 basic auth is supported.
18088
18089 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018090 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18091 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18092 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18093 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018094
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018095http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018096 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18097 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18098 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018099
18100http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018101 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18102 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18103 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018104
18105http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018106 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18107 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18108 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018110http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018111 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18112 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18114 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018116method : integer + string
18117 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18118 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18119 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18120 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18121 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18122 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18123 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018125 ACL derivatives :
18126 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018128 Example :
18129 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18130 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18131 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133path : string
18134 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18135 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18136 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18137 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18138 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018139 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018140 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018142 ACL derivatives :
18143 path : exact string match
18144 path_beg : prefix match
18145 path_dir : subdir match
18146 path_dom : domain match
18147 path_end : suffix match
18148 path_len : length match
18149 path_reg : regex match
18150 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018151
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018152pathq : string
18153 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18154 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18155 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18156 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18157 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18158 result in both cases.
18159
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018160query : string
18161 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18162 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18163 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18164 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018165 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018166 which stops before the question mark.
18167
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018168req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18169 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18170 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18171 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18172 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018174req.ver : string
18175req_ver : string (deprecated)
18176 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18177 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18178 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018180 ACL derivatives :
18181 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018182
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018183res.body : binary
18184 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18185 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18186 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18187 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18188
18189res.body_len : integer
18190 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18191 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18192 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18193 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18194
18195res.body_size : integer
18196 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18197 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18198 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18199 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18200 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18201 based expect rules.
18202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018203res.comp : boolean
18204 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18205 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18206 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208res.comp_algo : string
18209 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18210 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18211 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018213res.cook([<name>]) : string
18214scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18215 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18216 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018217 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18218 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018220 ACL derivatives :
18221 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18224scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18225 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18226 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018227 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18228 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18231scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18232 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18233 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018234 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18235 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018237res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18238 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18239 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18240 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18241 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18242 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18243 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18244 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18245 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018246 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18249 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18250 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18251 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18252 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018253 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18254 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018256res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18257shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18258 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18259 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18260 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18261 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18262 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18263 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18264 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018265 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18266 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018268 ACL derivatives :
18269 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18270 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18271 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18272 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18273 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18274 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18275 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18276 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18277
18278res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18279shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18280 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18281 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18282 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18283 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018284 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018286res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18287shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18288 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18289 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18290 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18291 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18292 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018293 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18294 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018295
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018296res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18297 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18298 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18299 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018300 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18301 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18304shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18305 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18306 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18307 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18308 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18309 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018310 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18311 based expect rules.
18312
18313res.hdrs : string
18314 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18315 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18316 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18317 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18318 based expect rules.
18319
18320res.hdrs_bin : binary
18321 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18322 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18323 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18324 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18325 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18326 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18327 (length of 0 for both).
18328
18329 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18330
18331 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18332 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018334res.ver : string
18335resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18336 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018337 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18338 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018340 ACL derivatives :
18341 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18344 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18345 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018346 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018347 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018349 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18350 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352status : integer
18353 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18354 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018355 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18356 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018357
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018358unique-id : string
18359 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18360 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18361 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18362 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18363 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18364 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366url : string
18367 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18368 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18369 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18370 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18371 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18372 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18373 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375 ACL derivatives :
18376 url : exact string match
18377 url_beg : prefix match
18378 url_dir : subdir match
18379 url_dom : domain match
18380 url_end : suffix match
18381 url_len : length match
18382 url_reg : regex match
18383 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018385url_ip : ip
18386 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18387 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18388 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18389 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18390 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18391 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18392 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018394url_port : integer
18395 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18396 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18397 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18398 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018399
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018400urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18401url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018402 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18403 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018404 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18405 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18406 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18407 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18409 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018410 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18411 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018413 ACL derivatives :
18414 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18415 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18416 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18417 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18418 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18419 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18420 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18421 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018422
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424 Example :
18425 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18426 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18427 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18428 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018429
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018430urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18432 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18433 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018434
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018435url32 : integer
18436 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18437 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18438 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18439 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18440 is an unsigned integer.
18441
18442url32+src : binary
18443 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18444 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18445 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18446
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018447
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200184487.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018449---------------------------------------
18450
18451This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18452used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18453purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18454There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18455or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18456any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18457for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18458
18459internal.htx.data : integer
18460 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18461 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18462
18463internal.htx.free : integer
18464 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18465 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18466
18467internal.htx.free_data : integer
18468 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18469 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18470
18471internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18472 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18473 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18474 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18475
18476internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18477 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18478 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18479
18480internal.htx.size : integer
18481 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18482 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18483
18484internal.htx.used : integer
18485 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18486 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18487 direction.
18488
18489internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18490 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18491 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18492 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18493 of the special value :
18494 * head : The oldest inserted block
18495 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018496 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018497
18498internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18499 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18500 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18501 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18502 integer or one of the special value :
18503 * head : The oldest inserted block
18504 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018505 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018506
18507internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18508 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18509 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18510 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18511 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18512
18513 * head : The oldest inserted block
18514 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018515 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018516
18517internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18518 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18519 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18520 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18521 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18522
18523 * head : The oldest inserted block
18524 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018525 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018526
18527internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18528 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18529 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18530 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18531 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18532
18533 * head : The oldest inserted block
18534 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018535 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018536
18537internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18538 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18539 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18540 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18541 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18542
18543 * head : The oldest inserted block
18544 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018545 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018546
18547internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18548 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18549 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18550 it returns false.
18551
18552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200185537.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018554---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018556Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18557every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018558order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018560ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18561---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018562FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018563HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018564HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18565HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018566HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18567HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18568HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18569HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18570LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018571METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018572METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018573METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18574METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18575METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18576METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018577METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018578METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018579RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018580REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018581TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018582WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18583---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018584
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185868. Logging
18587----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018588
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018589One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18590provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18591very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18592provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18593state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018594to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018595headers.
18596
18597In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18598about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18599send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18600
18601 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18602 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18603 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18604 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18605 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018606 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018607 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018608
18609The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18610allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18611as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18612while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18613real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18614delay.
18615
18616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186178.1. Log levels
18618---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018619
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018620TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018621source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018622HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18623in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18624track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18625syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18626about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018627
18628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186298.2. Log formats
18630----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018631
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018632HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018633and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18634slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18635options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018636
18637 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18638 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18639 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18640 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18641 extents.
18642
18643 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18644 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18645 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18646 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18647 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18648
18649 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18650 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18651 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18652 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18653 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18654
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018655 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18656 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18657 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18658 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18659
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018660 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18661
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018662Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18663specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18664field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18665servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18666always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18667identifier.
18668
18669Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18670 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18671 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18672 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18673 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18674
18675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186768.2.1. Default log format
18677-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018678
18679This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18680as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18681format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18682
18683 Example :
18684 listen www
18685 mode http
18686 log global
18687 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18688
18689 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18690 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18691 (www/HTTP)
18692
18693 Field Format Extract from the example above
18694 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18695 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18696 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18697 4 'to' to
18698 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18699 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18700
18701Detailed fields description :
18702 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18703 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18704 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18705 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18706 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18707 and processed the connection.
18708 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18709
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018710In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18711"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18712connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18713
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018714It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18715will eventually disappear.
18716
18717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187188.2.2. TCP log format
18719---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018720
18721The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18722is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18723information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18724counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18725emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18726environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18727the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18728sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018729specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18730not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18731fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18732marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018733
18734 Example :
18735 frontend fnt
18736 mode tcp
18737 option tcplog
18738 log global
18739 default_backend bck
18740
18741 backend bck
18742 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18743
18744 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18745 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18746 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18747
18748 Field Format Extract from the example above
18749 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18750 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18751 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18752 4 frontend_name fnt
18753 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18754 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18755 7 bytes_read* 212
18756 8 termination_state --
18757 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18758 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18759
18760Detailed fields description :
18761 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018762 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18763 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18764 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018765 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018766 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018767 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018768
18769 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018770 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18771 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18772 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018773
18774 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18775 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18776 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018777 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18778 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18779 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18780 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018781
18782 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18783 and processed the connection.
18784
18785 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18786 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18787 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18788 applications.
18789
18790 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18791 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18792 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18793 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18794 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18795
18796 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18797 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18798 See "Timers" below for more details.
18799
18800 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18801 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18802 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18803 "Timers" below for more details.
18804
18805 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018806 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018807 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18808 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18809 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18810 details.
18811
18812 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18813 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18814 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18815 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18816 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18817
18818 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18819 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18820 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18821 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18822 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18823 for more details.
18824
18825 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018826 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018827 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18828 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18829 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018830 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018831
18832 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18833 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18834 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18835 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18836 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18837 caused by a denial of service attack.
18838
18839 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18840 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18841 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18842 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18843 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18844 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18845 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18846 denial of service attack.
18847
18848 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18849 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18850 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18851 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18852 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18853 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18854 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18855 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18856 be processed than on other servers.
18857
18858 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18859 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18860 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18861 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18862 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18863 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18864 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18865 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18866 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18867 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18868 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18869 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18870 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18871
18872 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18873 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18874 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18875 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18876 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18877 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018878 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018879 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18880
18881 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18882 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18883 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18884 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18885 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18886 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018887 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018888 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18889 occurs.
18890
18891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188928.2.3. HTTP log format
18893----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018894
18895The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18896is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18897the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18898are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18899emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18900generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18901"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18902which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018903frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18904is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018905
18906Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18907slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18908with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18909
18910 Example :
18911 frontend http-in
18912 mode http
18913 option httplog
18914 log global
18915 default_backend bck
18916
18917 backend static
18918 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18919
18920 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18921 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18922 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018923 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018924
18925 Field Format Extract from the example above
18926 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18927 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018928 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018929 4 frontend_name http-in
18930 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018931 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018932 7 status_code 200
18933 8 bytes_read* 2750
18934 9 captured_request_cookie -
18935 10 captured_response_cookie -
18936 11 termination_state ----
18937 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18938 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18939 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18940 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18941 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018942
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018943Detailed fields description :
18944 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018945 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18946 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18947 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018948 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018949 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018950 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018951
18952 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018953 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18954 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18955 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018956
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018957 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18958 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018959
18960 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18961 and processed the connection.
18962
18963 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18964 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18965 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18966
18967 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18968 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18969 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18970 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18971 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18972 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18973
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018974 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18975 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18976 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018977 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018978 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18979 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018980 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18981 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018982
18983 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18984 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018985 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018986
18987 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18988 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018989 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18990 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018991
18992 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18993 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18994 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18995 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18996 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018997 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18998 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018999
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019000 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19001 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19002 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19003 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19004 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19005 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19006 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019007 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019008
19009 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19010 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19011 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19012
19013 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19014 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019015 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019016 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19017 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19018 overflowing.
19019
19020 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19021 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19022 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19023 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19024 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19025 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19026 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19027 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19028
19029 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19030 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19031 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19032 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19033 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19034 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19035 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19036 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19037
19038 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19039 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19040 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19041 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19042 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19043 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19044 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19045
19046 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019047 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019048 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19049 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19050 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019051 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019052 system.
19053
19054 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19055 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19056 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19057 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19058 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19059 caused by a denial of service attack.
19060
19061 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19062 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19063 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19064 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19065 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19066 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19067 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19068 denial of service attack.
19069
19070 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19071 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19072 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19073 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19074 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19075 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19076 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19077 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19078 processed than on other servers.
19079
19080 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19081 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19082 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19083 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19084 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19085 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19086 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19087 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19088 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19089 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19090 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19091 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19092 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19093
19094 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19095 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19096 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19097 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19098 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19099 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019100 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019101 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19102
19103 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19104 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19105 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19106 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19107 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19108 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019109 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019110 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19111 occurs.
19112
19113 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19114 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19115 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19116 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19117 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19118 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19119 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19120 cookies" below for more details.
19121
19122 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19123 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19124 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19125 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19126 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19127 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19128 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19129 and cookies" below for more details.
19130
19131 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19132 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19133 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19134 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19135 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19136 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19137 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19138 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19139
19140
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200191418.2.4. Custom log format
19142------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019143
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019144The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019145mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019146
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019147HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019148Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19149separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19150prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19151
19152Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19153variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019154("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019155
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019156If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019157as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019158less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19159the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19160
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019161Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19162"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19163delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19164preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019165
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019166Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19167'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19168https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19169such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19170
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019171Flags are :
19172 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019173 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019174 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19175 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019176
19177 Example:
19178
19179 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19180 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19181
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019182 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19183
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019184At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19185
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019186 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19187 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019188
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019189the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019190
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019191 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19192 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19193 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019194
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019195and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19196
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019197 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19198 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019199
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019200Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19201
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019202 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019203 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019204 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19205 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19206 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019207 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19208 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19209 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019210 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019211 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19212 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019213 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019214 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19215 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019216 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019217 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019218 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019219 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019220 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019221 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019222 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019223 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19224 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19225 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19226 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19227 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019228 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019229 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019230 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019231 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019232 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019233 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19234 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019235 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19236 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19237 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019238 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019239 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19240 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019241 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019242 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19243 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19244 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019245 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019246 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019247 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19248 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19249 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19250 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019251 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019252 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019253 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019254 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019255 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019256 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019257 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19258 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19259 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019260 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019261 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19262 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019263 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019264 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19265 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019266 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019267 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019268 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019269 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019270
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019271 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019272
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019273
192748.2.5. Error log format
19275-----------------------
19276
19277When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19278protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19279By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19280"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019281will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019282logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19283
19284The format looks like this :
19285
19286 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19287 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19288 Connection error during SSL handshake
19289
19290 Field Format Extract from the example above
19291 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19292 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19293 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19294 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19295 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19296
19297These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19298failures.
19299
19300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193018.3. Advanced logging options
19302-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019303
19304Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19305just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19306options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19307for more information about their usage.
19308
19309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193108.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19311------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019312
19313It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19314haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19315commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19316monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19317ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19318
19319 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19320 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19321 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19322 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19323
19324 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19325 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19326 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019327 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019328 such as other load-balancers.
19329
19330 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19331 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19332 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19333
19334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193358.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19336----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019337
19338The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19339what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19340or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019341"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019342just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19343log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19344after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19345is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19346with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19347with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19348
19349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193508.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19351------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019352
19353Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19354for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19355"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19356retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19357raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19358a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19359file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19360you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19361"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19362
19363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193648.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19365--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019366
19367Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19368multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19369them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19370"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19371logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19372error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19373and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19374too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19375useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19376alternative.
19377
19378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193798.4. Timing events
19380------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019381
19382Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19383reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19384the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19385frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019386mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19387addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19388
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019389Timings events in HTTP mode:
19390
19391 first request 2nd request
19392 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19393 t tr t tr ...
19394 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19395 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19396 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19397 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019398 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019399 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19400
19401Timings events in TCP mode:
19402
19403 TCP session
19404 |<----------------->|
19405 t t
19406 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19407 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19408 |<------ Tt ------->|
19409
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019410 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019411 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019412 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19413 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19414 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019415 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019416 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19417 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19418 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19419 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019420
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019421 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19422 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19423 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019424 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19425 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19426 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19427 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19428 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19429 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019430
19431 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19432 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19433 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19434 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19435 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19436 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19437 request typed by hand during a test.
19438
19439 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19440 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019441 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019442 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19443 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19444 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19445 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019446
19447 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19448 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19449 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19450 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19451 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19452
19453 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19454 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19455 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19456 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19457 connection never established.
19458
19459 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19460 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19461 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19462 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19463 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19464 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19465 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19466 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19467 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19468 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19469 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19470
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019471 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19472 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19473 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19474 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19475 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19476 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19477
19478 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19479
19480 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19481 "Ta" can never be negative.
19482
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019483 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19484 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019485 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19486 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019487 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019488
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019489 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019490
19491 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019492 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19493 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019494
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019495 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19496 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19497 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19498 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19499 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19500 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19501 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19502 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19503
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019504These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19505protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19506that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019507due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19508"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19509that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019510
19511Most common cases :
19512
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019513 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19514 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19515 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19516 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19517 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19518 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19519 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19520 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19521 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19522 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19523 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019524 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019525
19526 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19527 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19528 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19529 of ms on remote networks.
19530
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019531 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19532 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19533 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019534
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019535 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19536 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19537 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19538 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19539 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19540 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19541 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19542 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19543 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019544
19545Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19546
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019547 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019548 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019549 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019550
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019551 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019552 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19553 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19554
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019555 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019556 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19557 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19558 flags.
19559
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019560 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19561 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019562 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19563 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19564 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19565 the client connection was maintained open.
19566
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019567 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019568 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019569 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019570 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19571
19572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195738.5. Session state at disconnection
19574-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019575
19576TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19577"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195782-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19579each of which has a special meaning :
19580
19581 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19582 session to terminate :
19583
19584 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19585
19586 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19587 server explicitly refused it.
19588
19589 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19590 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19591 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19592 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019593 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019594
19595 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19596 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019597
19598 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19599 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19600 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19601 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19602 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19603
19604 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19605 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19606 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19607 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19608 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19609
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019610 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19611 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19612
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019613 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19614 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19615 backup connections when going up.
19616
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019617 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19618
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019619 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19620 send or receive data.
19621
19622 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19623 send or receive data.
19624
19625 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19626 with nothing left in the buffers.
19627
19628 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19629
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019630 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019631 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19632
19633 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19634 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19635 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19636 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19637 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19638
19639 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19640 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19641
19642 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19643 server (HTTP only).
19644
19645 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19646
19647 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19648 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19649 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19650
19651 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19652 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19653 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19654
19655 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19656
19657 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19658 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19659
19660 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19661 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19662 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19663
19664 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19665 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019666 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19667 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019668
19669 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19670 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19671 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19672 another server.
19673
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019674 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019675 server.
19676
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019677 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19678 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19679 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19680 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19681
19682 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19683 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19684 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19685 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19686
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019687 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19688 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19689 "use-server" rule).
19690
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019691 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19692
19693 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19694 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19695
19696 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19697
19698 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19699 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19700 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19701
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019702 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19703 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019704 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019705 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19706 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19707
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019708 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19709
19710 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19711 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19712
19713 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19714
19715 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19716
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019717The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19718was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019719helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19720starvation, attacks, etc...
19721
19722The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19723alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19724easier finding and understanding.
19725
19726 Flags Reason
19727
19728 -- Normal termination.
19729
19730 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19731 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19732 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19733 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19734
19735 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19736 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19737 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19738 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19739 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19740 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019741
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019742 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19743 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019744 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019745
19746 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19747 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19748 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19749
19750 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19751 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19752 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19753 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19754 the server takes too long to respond.
19755
19756 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19757 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19758 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19759 long a time to respond.
19760
19761 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19762 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19763 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19764 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019765 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19766 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019767
19768 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19769 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19770 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19771 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19772 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019773 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019774 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19775 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19776 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19777 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19778 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19779 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19780 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19781 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019782 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019783 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19784 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19785 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019786
19787 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19788 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019789 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19790 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19791 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19792 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019793
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019794 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19795 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019797 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019798 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19799 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019800 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019801 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19802 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19803
19804 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19805 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19806 503 or 504 here.
19807
19808 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19809 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19810 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19811 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19812 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19813
19814 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19815 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019816 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019817 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19818 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19819
19820 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19821 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19822 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19823 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19824 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19825 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19826 between haproxy and the server.
19827
19828 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19829 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19830 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19831 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19832 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19833 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19834 solution is to fix the application.
19835
19836 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19837 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19838 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19839 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19840 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19841 external attacks.
19842
19843 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19844 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019845 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019846 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19847 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19848
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019849 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19850 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19851 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019852 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019853 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019854
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019855 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19856 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19857 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19858 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019859 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19860 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19861 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19862 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19863 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019864
19865 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19866 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19867 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19868 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19869
19870 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19871 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19872 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19873 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19874
19875 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19876 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19877 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19878 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19879
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019880The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19881persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19882important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19883re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19884
19885 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19886
19887 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19888 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19889 set on a GET request.
19890
19891 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19892 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019893 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019894 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19895
19896 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19897 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19898 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19899
19900 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19901 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19902 already got a cookie.
19903
19904 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19905 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19906 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19907 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19908 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19909
19910 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19911 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19912 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19913
19914 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19915 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19916 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19917
19918 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19919 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19920
19921 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19922 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19923 then advertised in the response.
19924
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199268.6. Non-printable characters
19927-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019928
19929In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19930consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19931converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19932prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19933being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19934escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19935is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19936'}' when logging headers.
19937
19938Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19939issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19940containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19941
19942Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19943the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19944performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19945
19946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199478.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19948---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019949
19950Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19951achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019952section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019953cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19954the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19955the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019956locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019957not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19958user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19959a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19960wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19961
19962 Examples :
19963 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19964 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19965
19966 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19967 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19968
19969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199708.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19971---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019972
19973Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19974proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19975the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19976server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19977
19978Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19979response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019980section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019981
19982It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019983time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19984appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019985are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19986and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19987follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19988request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19989in the logs.
19990
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019991As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19992frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19993an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19994
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019995 Example :
19996 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19997 listen proxy-out
19998 mode http
19999 option httplog
20000 option logasap
20001 log global
20002 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20003
20004 # log the name of the virtual server
20005 capture request header Host len 20
20006
20007 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20008 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20009
20010 # log the beginning of the referrer
20011 capture request header Referer len 20
20012
20013 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20014 capture response header Server len 20
20015
20016 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20017 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20018
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020019 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020020 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20021
20022 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20023 capture response header Via len 20
20024
20025 # log the URL location during a redirection
20026 capture response header Location len 20
20027
20028 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20029 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20030 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20031 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20032 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20033
20034 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20035 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20036 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20037 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020038 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020039
20040 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20041 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20042 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20043 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20044 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020045 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020046
20047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200488.9. Examples of logs
20049---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020050
20051These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20052them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20053reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20054
20055 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20056 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20057 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20058
20059 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20060 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20061
20062 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20063 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20064 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20065
20066 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20067 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20068
20069 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20070 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20071 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20072
20073 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020074 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020075 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20076 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20077
20078 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20079 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20080 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20081
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020082 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20083 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20084 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20085 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20086 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20087 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020088
20089 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020090 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020091
20092 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20093 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20094 Nothing was sent to any server.
20095
20096 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20097 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20098
20099 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20100 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020101 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020102 send a 408 return code to the client.
20103
20104 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20105 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20106
20107 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20108 5 seconds ("c----").
20109
20110 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20111 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020112 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113
20114 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020115 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020116 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20117 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20118 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20119 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20120 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020121
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020122
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200201239. Supported filters
20124--------------------
20125
20126Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20127accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20128unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20129
20130See also : "filter"
20131
201329.1. Trace
20133----------
20134
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020135filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020136
20137 Arguments:
20138 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20139 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20140
20141 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20142 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20143 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20144 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20145
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020146 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020147 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20148 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20149 amount of the parsed data.
20150
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020151 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020152
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020153This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20154callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20155information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20156filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20157
20158Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20159tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20160a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20161
20162
201639.2. HTTP compression
20164---------------------
20165
20166filter compression
20167
20168The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20169keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020170when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20171fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20172done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20173explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20174filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20175listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20176order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020177
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020178See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20179 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020180
20181
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201829.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20183--------------------------------------------
20184
20185filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20186
20187 Arguments :
20188
20189 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20190 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20191 parsed.
20192
20193 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20194 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20195 part must be placed in its own scope.
20196
20197The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20198external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020199streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020200exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20201also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20202
20203SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20204the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20205
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020206For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020207"doc/SPOE.txt".
20208
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100202099.4. Cache
20210----------
20211
20212filter cache <name>
20213
20214 Arguments :
20215
20216 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20217
20218The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20219"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020220cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020221other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20222case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20223is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20224filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020225listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20226order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020227
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020228See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20229 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20230
20231
202329.5. Fcgi-app
20233-------------
20234
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020235filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020236
20237 Arguments :
20238
20239 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20240
20241The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20242request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20243reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20244used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20245implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20246used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20247fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20248used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20249order.
20250
20251See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20252 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20253
20254
2025510. FastCGI applications
20256-------------------------
20257
20258HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20259feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20260the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20261FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20262servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20263FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20264backend.
20265
20266HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20267application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20268connection.
20269
2027010.1. Setup
20271-----------
20272
2027310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20274--------------------------
20275
20276fcgi-app <name>
20277 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20278 document root must be defined.
20279
20280acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20281 Declare or complete an access list.
20282
20283 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20284 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20285 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20286 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20287 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20288
20289docroot <path>
20290 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20291 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20292 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20293
20294index <script-name>
20295 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20296 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20297 is an optional setting.
20298
20299 Example :
20300 index index.php
20301
20302log-stderr global
20303log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20304 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20305 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20306
20307 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20308 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20309
20310pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20311 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20312 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20313 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20314
20315 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20316 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20317 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20318 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20319
20320 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20321 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20322
20323path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020324 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020325 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20326 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20327 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20328 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20329 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20330 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20331 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020332
20333 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020334 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020335 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20336 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20337 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20338 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020339
20340 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020341 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20342 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020343
20344option get-values
20345no option get-values
20346 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20347
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020348 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020349 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20350
20351 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20352 application will accept.
20353
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020354 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20355 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020356
20357 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020358 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020359 option is disabled.
20360
20361 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20362 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20363 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20364 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20365 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20366 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20367
20368option keep-conn
20369no option keep-conn
20370 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20371 sending a response.
20372
20373 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20374 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20375
20376option max-reqs <reqs>
20377 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20378 accept.
20379
20380 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20381 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20382 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20383 to 1.
20384
20385option mpxs-conns
20386no option mpxs-conns
20387 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20388
20389 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20390 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20391
20392set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20393 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20394 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20395 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20396 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20397
20398 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20399 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20400 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20401
20402 Example :
20403 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20404 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20405
20406 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20407
20408
2040910.1.2. Proxy section
20410---------------------
20411
20412use-fcgi-app <name>
20413 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20414
20415 Arguments :
20416 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20417
20418 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20419 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20420 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20421 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20422 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20423
20424 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20425 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20426 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20427 application are evaluated.
20428
20429
2043010.1.3. Example
20431---------------
20432
20433 frontend front-http
20434 mode http
20435 bind *:80
20436 bind *:
20437
20438 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20439 default_backend back-static
20440
20441 backend back-static
20442 mode http
20443 server www A.B.C.D:80
20444
20445 backend back-dynamic
20446 mode http
20447 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20448 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20449
20450 fcgi-app php-fpm
20451 log-stderr global
20452 option keep-conn
20453
20454 docroot /var/www/my-app
20455 index index.php
20456 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20457
20458
2045910.2. Default parameters
20460------------------------
20461
20462A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20463the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020464script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020465applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20466
20467 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20468 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20469 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20470 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20471 | | |
20472 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20473 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20474 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20475 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20476 | | application. |
20477 | | |
20478 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20479 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20480 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20481 | | |
20482 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20483 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20484 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20485 | | the application's configuration. |
20486 | | |
20487 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20488 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20489 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20490 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20491 | | |
20492 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20493 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20494 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20495 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20496 | | be defined. |
20497 | | |
20498 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20499 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20500 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20501 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20502 | | is not set too. |
20503 | | |
20504 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20505 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20506 | | set. |
20507 | | |
20508 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20509 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20510 | | the request. |
20511 | | |
20512 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20513 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20514 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20515 | | |
20516 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20517 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20518 | | script to process the request. |
20519 | | |
20520 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20521 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20522 | | |
20523 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20524 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20525 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20526 | | |
20527 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20528 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20529 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20530 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20531 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20532 | | |
20533 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20534 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20535 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20536 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20537 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20538 | | side. |
20539 | | |
20540 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20541 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20542 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20543 | | connected to. |
20544 | | |
20545 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20546 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20547 | | |
20548 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20549 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20550 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20551 | | |
20552 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20553
20554
2055510.3. Limitations
20556------------------
20557
20558The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20559way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20560during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20561establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20562application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20563or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20564message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20565these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20566and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20567
20568Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20569request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20570requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20571
20572About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20573into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20574fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20575"http-request" ones.
20576
20577Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20578FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20579processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20580must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20581here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020582
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020583/*
20584 * Local variables:
20585 * fill-column: 79
20586 * End:
20587 */